blob: 5eef1ff88b876126f331de03dd8e6a7d8ace8ced [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau1a38ffc2020-11-21 16:00:40 +01007 2020/11/21
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200121
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012210. FastCGI applications
12310.1. Setup
12410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12510.1.2. Proxy section
12610.1.3. Example
12710.2. Default parameters
12810.3. Limitations
129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130
1311. Quick reminder about HTTP
132----------------------------
133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
136on almost anything found in the contents.
137
138However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
139formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
140correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
141
142
1431.1. The HTTP transaction model
144-------------------------------
145
146The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100147to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
149connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150will involve a new connection :
151
152 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
153
154In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
155establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
156by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
157length.
158
159Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
160to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
161however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
162response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
163header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
168power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
169but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
174second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
175page :
176
177 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
178
179This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
180latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
181correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
182the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100183server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100185The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
186time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
187are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
188parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
189carry the stream identifier.
190
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
192connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
193leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
195processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
196waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200198HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100199 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
200 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100201 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206
2071.2. HTTP request
208-----------------
209
210First, let's consider this HTTP request :
211
212 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
215 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
216 3 User-agent: my small browser
217 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
218 5 Accept: image/png
219
220
2211.2.1. The Request line
222-----------------------
223
224Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
225
226 - a METHOD : GET
227 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
228 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
229
230All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
231which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
232followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
233is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
234desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
235the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
236
237The URI itself can have several forms :
238
239 - A "relative URI" :
240
241 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
244 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
245
246 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
247
248 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
251 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
252 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
253 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
254 must accept this form too.
255
256 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
257 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
258 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200260 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
261 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
262 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
263 other protocols too.
264
265In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
266mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
267on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
268It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
269specific to the language, framework or application in use.
270
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100271HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100272assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274
2751.2.2. The request headers
276--------------------------
277
278The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
279beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
280an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
281Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
282values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
283encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
284the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
285define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100287Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100289"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200290as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
291normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
292representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
293HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294
295The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
296that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
297is one valid form of empty line.
298
299Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
300headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
301about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
302application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
303
304Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000305 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
307 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
308 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
309
310
3111.3. HTTP response
312------------------
313
314An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
315messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
316
317 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100318 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
320 2 Content-length: 350
321 3 Content-Type: text/html
322
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200323As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
324codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
325response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100326continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
327the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
328following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
329sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
330(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
331correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
332such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
333state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
334over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
335if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
336information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200338
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003391.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340------------------------
341
342Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
343
344 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
345 - a status code : 200
346 - a reason : OK
347
348The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100349 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
350 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
351 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
352 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
353 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000355Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100356"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200357found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
358messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
359or "Authentication Required".
360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362
363 Code When / reason
364 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
365 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100368 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370 400 for an invalid or too large request
371 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
372 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200373 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100374 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100376 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
377 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
379 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
380 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200381 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
383 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
384 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
385
386The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3874.2).
388
389
3901.3.2. The response headers
391---------------------------
392
393Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
394the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
395details.
396
397
3982. Configuring HAProxy
399----------------------
400
4012.1. Configuration file format
402------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200403
404HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
405
406 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100407 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
408 - the running process' environment, in case some environment variables are
409 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100411The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
412a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
415
416 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
417
418 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
419 tab characters
420
421 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
422 keyword sequences listed in this document
423
424 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
425 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
426 parts of the configuration, or expressions
427
428 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
429 are supported
430
431 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
432 section
433
434This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
435generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
436figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
437
438First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
439the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
440a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
441word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
442follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
443the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
444the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
445the parts that need to be addressed.
446
447A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
448requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
449extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
450the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
451section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
452section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
453not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
454
455A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
456each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
457a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
458start a new one.
459
460Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
461that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
462applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
463"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
464processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
465ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
466which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
467In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
468of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
469identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
470such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4712, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
472
473 listen foo
474 bind :80
475
476 listen bar
477 bind :81
478
479Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
480spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
481of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
482following configurations are strictly equivalent:
483
484 global#this is the global section
485 daemon#daemonize
486 frontend foo
487 mode http # or tcp
488
489and:
490
491 global
492 daemon
493
494 # this is the public web frontend
495 frontend foo
496 mode http
497
498The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
499new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
500other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
501section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
502section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
503at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
504
505Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
506are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
507editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
508support automatic indent.
509
510In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
511positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
512modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
513anymore, and is not recommended.
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005162.2. Quoting and escaping
517-------------------------
518
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100519In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
520that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
521possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
522in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
523('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200524
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100525This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
526very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
527the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
528also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
529delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
530word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
531remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
534(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
535
536Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
537backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200538
539 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
540 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
541 \\ to use a backslash
542 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
543 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
544
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100545In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
546C-language representation:
547
548 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
549 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
550 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
551 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
552
553Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
554or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
555of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200556
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100557 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200558 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
559 # hash as a comment start
560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
562evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
563dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
564backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
567character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
568is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
571entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
572name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
573represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
574hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
577 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
578 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
579 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
580 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
581 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
582 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
583 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
584 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
585 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
586 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200587
588 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100589 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
591 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
592 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
593 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
595
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
597necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
598by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
599they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
600escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
601characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
602case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
603if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
604own quotes.
605
606The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
607quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
608not always obvious is that the delimitors used inside must first be escaped or
609quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
610
611Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
612arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
613
614 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
615 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
616
617Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
618"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
619cannot write:
620
621 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
622
623because we would like the string to cut like this:
624
625 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
626 |---------|----|-|
627 arg1 _/ / /
628 arg2 __________/ /
629 arg3 ______________/
630
631but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
632parenthesis then garbage:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |--------|--------|
636 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
637 trailing garbage _________/
638
639The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
640quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
641processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
642this word:
643
644 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
645 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
646 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
649still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
650the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
651the second level:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
656 |---------||----|-|
657 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
658 arg2=blah ___________/ /
659 arg3=g _______________/
660
661Another approch consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
662double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
663
664 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
665 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
666 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
667 |---------||----|-|
668 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
669 arg2 ___________/ /
670 arg3 _______________/
671
672When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
673appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
674string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
675thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
676
677 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
678 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
680 |-------------| |-----||-|
681 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
682 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
683 arg3 ______________________/
684
685Remember that backslahes are not escape characters withing single quotes and
686that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
687quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
688single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
689level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
690
691When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
692double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
693and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
694a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
695a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
696the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
697regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
698around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
699more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200700
701
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007022.3. Environment variables
703--------------------------
704
705HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
706interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
707configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
708optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
709shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200710underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
711list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
712arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
713before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200714
715 Example:
716
717 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
718
719 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
720
721 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
722
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200723Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
724file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
727 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
728
729* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
730 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
731 directory.
732
733* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
734
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500735* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200736 processes, separated by semicolons.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 CLI, separated by semicolons.
740
741See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200742
7432.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200744----------------
745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100746Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100747values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
748otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
749numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
750for every keyword. Supported units are :
751
752 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
753 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
754 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
755 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
756 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
757 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
758
759
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007602.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200761-------------
762
763 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
764 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
765 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
766 global
767 daemon
768 maxconn 256
769
770 defaults
771 mode http
772 timeout connect 5000ms
773 timeout client 50000ms
774 timeout server 50000ms
775
776 frontend http-in
777 bind *:80
778 default_backend servers
779
780 backend servers
781 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
782
783
784 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
785 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
786 global
787 daemon
788 maxconn 256
789
790 defaults
791 mode http
792 timeout connect 5000ms
793 timeout client 50000ms
794 timeout server 50000ms
795
796 listen http-in
797 bind *:80
798 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
799
800
801Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
802
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100803 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200804
805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807--------------------
808
809Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
810are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
811of them have command-line equivalents.
812
813The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
814
815 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200819 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200821 - description
822 - deviceatlas-json-file
823 - deviceatlas-log-level
824 - deviceatlas-separator
825 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900826 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827 - gid
828 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100829 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200830 - h1-case-adjust
831 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100833 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100834 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200835 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200836 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200837 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100838 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200839 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100840 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200841 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200843 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200844 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200845 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200846 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100847 - presetenv
848 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - uid
850 - ulimit-n
851 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200852 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100853 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200854 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200855 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200856 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200857 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200858 - ssl-default-bind-options
859 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200861 - ssl-default-server-options
862 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100863 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200864 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100865 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100866 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100867 - 51degrees-data-file
868 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200869 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200870 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200871 - wurfl-data-file
872 - wurfl-information-list
873 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200874 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100875 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100876
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100878 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200879 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200881 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100882 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100883 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100884 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200885 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200886 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200887 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200888 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889 - noepoll
890 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000891 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200892 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100893 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300894 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000895 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100896 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200898 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200899 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000900 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000901 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200902 - tune.buffers.limit
903 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200904 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200905 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100906 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200907 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200908 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200909 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200910 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100911 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200912 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200913 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200914 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100915 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100916 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100917 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100918 - tune.lua.session-timeout
919 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200920 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100921 - tune.maxaccept
922 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200923 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200924 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200925 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200926 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
927 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100928 - tune.rcvbuf.client
929 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100930 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200931 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200932 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100933 - tune.sndbuf.client
934 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100935 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200936 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100937 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200938 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100939 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200940 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200941 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100942 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200943 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100944 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200945 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
946 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
947 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100948 - tune.zlib.memlevel
949 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200953 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954
955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957------------------------------------
958
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200959ca-base <dir>
960 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100961 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
962 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
963 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965chroot <jail dir>
966 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
967 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
968 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
969 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
970 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100972
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100973cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
974 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
975 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
976 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
977 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
978 set. These sets have the format
979
980 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
981
982 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100983 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100984 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
985 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100986 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
987 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100988 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100989 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100990 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100992 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
993 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
994 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
995 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100996
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100997 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
998 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
999 on the machine's word size.
1000
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001001 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001002 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1003 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1004 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1005 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1006 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1007 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001008
1009 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001010 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1011
1012 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1013 # first 4 CPUs
1014
1015 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1016 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1017 # word size.
1018
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001019 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001020 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001021 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1022 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1023 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1024
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001025 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1026 # and so on.
1027 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1028 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1029 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1030
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001031 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001032 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1033 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1034 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1035
1036 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1037 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1038 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1039
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001040 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1041 # and a thread range.
1042 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1043 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1044 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1045
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001046crt-base <dir>
1047 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001048 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1049 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051daemon
1052 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1053 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001054 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1055 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001057deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1058 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001059 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001060
1061deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001062 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001063 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1064
1065deviceatlas-separator <char>
1066 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1067 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1068
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001069deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001070 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1071 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1072 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001073
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001074external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001075 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1076 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001077 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1078 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1079 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1080 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1081 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083gid <number>
1084 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
1085 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1086 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001087 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1088 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001090
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001091group <group name>
1092 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1093 See also "gid" and "user".
1094
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001095hard-stop-after <time>
1096 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1097
1098 Arguments :
1099 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1100 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1101 SIGUSR1 signal.
1102
1103 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1104 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1105 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1106
1107 Example:
1108 global
1109 hard-stop-after 30s
1110
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001111h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1112 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1113 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1114 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1115 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001116 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001117 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1118 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1119 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1120 specified in a proxy.
1121
1122 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1123 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1124 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1125 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1126 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1127 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1128 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1129
1130 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1131 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1132 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1133 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1134 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1135
1136 Example:
1137 global
1138 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1139
1140 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1141 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1142
1143h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1144 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1145 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1146 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1147 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1148 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1149 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1150 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1151 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1152
1153 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1154 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1155 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1156
1157 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1158 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1159
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001160insecure-fork-wanted
1161 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1162 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1163 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1164 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1165 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1166 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1167 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1168 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1169 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1170 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1171 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1172 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1173 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1174 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1175 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1176 disable it.
1177
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001178insecure-setuid-wanted
1179 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1180 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1181 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1182 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1183 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1184 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1185 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1186 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1187 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1188 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1189 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1190 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1191 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1192 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1193
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001194issuers-chain-path <dir>
1195 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1196 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1197 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1198 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1199 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1200 "issuers-chain-path".
1201 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1202 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1203 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1204 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1205 will share the chain in memory.
1206
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001207localpeer <name>
1208 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1209 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1210 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1211 the configuration parsing.
1212
1213 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1214 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1215
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001216log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
1217 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001218 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001219 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001220 configured with "log global".
1221
1222 <address> can be one of:
1223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001224 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001225 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1226 port).
1227
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001228 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001232 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001233 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1234 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001235 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001236
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001237 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1238 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1239 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1240 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1241 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1242 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1243 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1244 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1245 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1246 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1247 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1248 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1249 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1250 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001251 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1252 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001253
1254 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1255 "fd@2", see above.
1256
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001257 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1258 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1259 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1260 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1261 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1262
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001263 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1264 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001265
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001266 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1267 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1268 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1269 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1270 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1271 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1272 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1273 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1274 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1275 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1277 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001278
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001279 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1280 one of the following :
1281
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001282 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1283 field is stripped. This is the default.
1284 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1285 rfc3164.
1286
1287 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001288 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1289
1290 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1291 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1292
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001293 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1294 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1295 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1296 designed to be used with a local log server.
1297
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001298 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1299 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1300 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1301 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1302 logger consumes.
1303
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001304 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1305 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1306 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1307 used with a local log server.
1308
1309 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1310 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1311 designed to be used with a local log server.
1312
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001313 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1314 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1315 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1316 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1317
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001318 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1319 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1320 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1321 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1322 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1323
1324 <sample_size>
1325 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1326 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1327 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1328 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1329 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1330
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001331 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001332
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001333 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1334 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1335 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1336
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001337 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1338 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1339 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1340 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001341
1342 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001343 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1344 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1345 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1346 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1347 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1348 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001349
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001350 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001351
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001352log-send-hostname [<string>]
1353 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1354 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1355 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1356 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1357 the logs.
1358
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001359log-tag <string>
1360 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1361 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1362 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001363 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001364
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001365lua-load <file>
1366 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1367 used multiple times.
1368
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001369lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1370 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1371 variable.
1372 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1373 to "path".
1374
1375 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1376 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1377 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1378 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1379 will be checked earlier.
1380
1381 As an example by specifying the following path:
1382
1383 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1384 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1385
1386 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1387 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1388 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1389 paths if that does not exist either.
1390
1391 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1392 documentation.
1393
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001394master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001395 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1396 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1397 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001398 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001399 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1400 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001401 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1402 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1403 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1404 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1405 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001406
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001407 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001408
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001409mworker-max-reloads <number>
1410 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001411 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001412 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1413 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1414 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1415
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001416nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001417 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1418 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1419 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001420 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1421 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001422 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1423 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1424 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001425
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001426nbthread <number>
1427 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001428 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1429 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1430 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1431 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1432 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001433 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1434 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1435 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1436 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1437 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1438 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1439 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001440
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001442 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1443 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1444 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1445 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001447pp2-never-send-local
1448 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1449 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1450 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1451 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1452 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1453 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1454 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1455 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1456 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1457 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1458 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1459
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001460presetenv <name> <value>
1461 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1462 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1463 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1464 and "unsetenv".
1465
1466resetenv [<name> ...]
1467 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1468 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1469 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1470 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1471 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1472 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1473 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1474 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1475
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001476stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001477 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1478 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1479 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1480 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1481 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1482 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001483 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001484 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1485 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1486 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1487 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001488
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001489server-state-base <directory>
1490 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001491 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1492 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001493
1494server-state-file <file>
1495 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1496 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1497 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1498 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1499 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1500 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1501 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1502 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001503 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1504 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001505
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001506setenv <name> <value>
1507 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1508 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1509 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1510 and "unsetenv".
1511
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001512set-dumpable
1513 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001514 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1515 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1516 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1517 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1518 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1519 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1520 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1521 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1522 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1523 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1524 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1525 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1526 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1527 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1528 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1529 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1530 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001531
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001532ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1534 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001535 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001536 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001537 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1538 information and recommendations see e.g.
1539 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1540 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1541 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1542 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001543
1544ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1546 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1547 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1548 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1549 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001550 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1551 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1552 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001553 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001554
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001555ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1557 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1558 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1559 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1560 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1561
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001562ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1564 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1565 keyword to see available options.
1566
1567 Example:
1568 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001569 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001570
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001571ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1573 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001574 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001575 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001576 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1577 information and recommendations see e.g.
1578 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1579 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1580 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1581 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1582 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001583
1584ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1586 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1587 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1588 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1589 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001590 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1591 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1592 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1593 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001594
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001595ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1597 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1598 keyword to see available options.
1599
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001600ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1602 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1603 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001605 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001606 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1607 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1608 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1609 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001610 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1611 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1612 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1613
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001614ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1615 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1616 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001617 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001618 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001619 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1620
1621 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001622
1623 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1624 and won't try to remove them.
1625
1626 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1627
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001628ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001629 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001630 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1631 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001632
1633 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1634 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1635 optimize the startup time.
1636
1637 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1638 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1639 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1640
1641 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001642 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001643
1644 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001645 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1646
1647 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1648 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1649 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1650 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1651 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1652 bind configuration..
1653
1654 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1655 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1656 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1657 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1658 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1659 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1660 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1661 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1662
1663 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1664
1665 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1666 a cert bundle.
1667
1668 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1669 separately in several "crt".
1670
1671 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1672 since files are loading separately.
1673
1674 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1675 required to commit them.
1676
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001677 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001678 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001679
1680 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1681
1682 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1683
1684 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1685 not provided in the PEM file.
1686
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001687 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1688 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1689
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001690 The default behavior is "all".
1691
1692 Example:
1693 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1694 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1695 ssl-load-extra-files none
1696
1697 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1698
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001699ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1700 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1701 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1702 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1703
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001704ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001705 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001706 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1707 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1708 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1709 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1710 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1711 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001712 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001713
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001714stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1715 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1716 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1717 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001718 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001719 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001720
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001721 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1722 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1723 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001724
1725stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1726 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1727 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001728 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001729
1730stats maxconn <connections>
1731 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1732 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001734uid <number>
1735 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1736 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1737 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1738 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1739
1740ulimit-n <number>
1741 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1742 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1743 option.
1744
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001745unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1746 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1747
1748 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1749 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1750 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1751 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1752 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1753 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1754 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1755 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1756 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1757 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1758
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001759unsetenv [<name> ...]
1760 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1761 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1762 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1763 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1764 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1765 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1766 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001768user <user name>
1769 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1770 See also "uid" and "group".
1771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001772node <name>
1773 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1774
1775 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1776 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1777 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1778 traffic.
1779
1780description <text>
1781 Add a text that describes the instance.
1782
1783 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1784 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1785 "<" and ">" characters.
1786
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100178751degrees-data-file <file path>
1788 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001789 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001790
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001791 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001792 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1793
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000179451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001795 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1796 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1797 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1798
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001799 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001800 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1801
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200180251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001803 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1804 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1805
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001806 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1807 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1808
180951degrees-cache-size <number>
1810 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1811 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1812 By default, this cache is disabled.
1813
1814 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001815 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1816
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001817wurfl-data-file <file path>
1818 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1819 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1820
1821 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1822 with USE_WURFL=1.
1823
1824wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1825 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1826 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1827 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1828
1829 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1830
1831 Valid WURFL properties are:
1832 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1833
1834 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1835 device.
1836
1837 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1838 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1839
1840 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1841 particular web request.
1842
1843 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1844 used Libwurfl API version.
1845
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001846 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1847 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1848
1849 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1850 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1851
1852 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1853
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001854 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1855 with USE_WURFL=1.
1856
1857wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1858 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1859 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1860
1861 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1862 with USE_WURFL=1.
1863
1864wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1865 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1866 thus before the chroot.
1867
1868 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1869 with USE_WURFL=1.
1870
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001871wurfl-cache-size <size>
1872 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1873 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001874 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001875 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001876
1877 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1878 with USE_WURFL=1.
1879
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001880strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001881 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1882 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1883 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1884 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1885 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018873.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888-----------------------
1889
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001890busy-polling
1891 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1892 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1893 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1894 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1895 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1896 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1897 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1898 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1899 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1900 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1901 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1902 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1903 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1904 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1905 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1906 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1907 "poll" pollers.
1908
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001909 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1910 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1911 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1912
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001913max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1914 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1915 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1916 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1917 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1918 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1919 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1920 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1921 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1922
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001923maxconn <number>
1924 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1925 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1926 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001927 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1928 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1929 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1930 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001931 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1932 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1933 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1934 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1935 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1936 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001937
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001938maxconnrate <number>
1939 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1940 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1941 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1942 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1943 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1944 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1945 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1946 fairness.
1947
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001948maxcomprate <number>
1949 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001950 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001951 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1952 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1953 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001954 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001955 default value.
1956
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001957maxcompcpuusage <number>
1958 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1959 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1960 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1961 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1962 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1963 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1964 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1965 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1966
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001967maxpipes <number>
1968 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1969 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1970 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1971 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1972 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1973 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1974
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001975maxsessrate <number>
1976 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1977 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1978 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1979 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1980 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1981 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1982 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1983 fairness.
1984
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001985maxsslconn <number>
1986 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1987 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1988 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1989 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1990 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1991 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1992 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001993 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1994 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1995 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1996 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1997 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1998 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1999 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002000
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002001maxsslrate <number>
2002 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2003 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2004 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2005 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2006 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2007 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2008 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2009 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2010 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2011 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2012
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002013maxzlibmem <number>
2014 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2015 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2016 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002017 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2018 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2019 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2020
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002021noepoll
2022 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002025
2026nokqueue
2027 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2028 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2029 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2030
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002031noevports
2032 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2033 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2034 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2035 also "nopoll".
2036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037nopoll
2038 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2039 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002041 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2042 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002043
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002044nosplice
2045 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002046 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002047 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002048 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002049 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2050 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2051 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2052 "option splice-response".
2053
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002054nogetaddrinfo
2055 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2056 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2057
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002058noreuseport
2059 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2060 command line argument "-dR".
2061
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002062profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2063 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2064 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2065 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2066 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002067 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002068 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2069 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2070 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2071 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2072
2073 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2074 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2075 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2076 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2077 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002078 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2079 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2080 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2081 CLI.
2082
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002083spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002084 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2085 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2086 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2087 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2088 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2089 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002091ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002092 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002093 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002094 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2095 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2096 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2097 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2098 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002099 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2100 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002101 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2102 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2103 openssl configuration file uses:
2104 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2105
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002106ssl-mode-async
2107 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002108 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002109 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2110 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2111 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002112 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002113 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002114
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002115tune.buffers.limit <number>
2116 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2117 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2118 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2119 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2120 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002121 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002122 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2123 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2124 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2125 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2126 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2127 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2128 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2129 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2130 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2131
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002132tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2133 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2134 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2135 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2136 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2137
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002138tune.bufsize <number>
2139 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2140 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2141 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2142 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2143 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2144 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2145 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002146 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2147 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2148 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002149 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002150 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2151 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2152 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002153
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002154tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2155 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002156
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002157tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2158 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2159 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2160 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2161 this value. The default value is 1.
2162
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002163tune.fail-alloc
2164 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2165 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2166 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2167 gracefully.
2168
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002169tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2170 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2171 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2172 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2173 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2174 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2175
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002176tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2177 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2178 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2179 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2180 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2181 change it.
2182
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002183tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2184 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002185 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2186 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002187 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2188 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2189 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2190 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2191 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2192
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002193tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2194 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2195 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2196 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2197 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2198 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2199 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2200 recommended not to change this value.
2201
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002202tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2203 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2204 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2205 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2206 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2207 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2208 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2209 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2210
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002211tune.http.cookielen <number>
2212 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2213 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2214 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2215 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2216 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2217 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2218 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2219 to change this value.
2220
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002221tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002222 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2223 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002224 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002225 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002226 configuration directives too.
2227 The default value is 1024.
2228
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002229tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2230 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2231 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2232 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2233 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2234 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2235 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002236 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2237 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2238 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002239
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002240tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2241 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2242 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2243 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2244 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2245 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2246 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2247 this option to "off". The default is on.
2248
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002249tune.idletimer <timeout>
2250 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2251 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2252 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2253 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2254 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2255 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002256 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002257 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002258 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2259
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002260tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2261 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2262 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2263 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2264 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2265 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2266 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2267 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2268 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2269 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2270
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002271tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2272 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002273 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002274 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2275 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002276 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002277 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2278 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2279
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002280tune.lua.maxmem
2281 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2282 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2283 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2284 memory.
2285
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002286tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2287 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002288 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2289 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002290 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002291
2292tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2293 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2294 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2295 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2296 check servers.
2297
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002298tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2299 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2300 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2301 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002302 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002303
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002304tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002305 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2306 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2307 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2308 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2309 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2310 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2311 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2312 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2313 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2314 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002315
2316tune.maxpollevents <number>
2317 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2318 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2319 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2320 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2321 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2322
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002323tune.maxrewrite <number>
2324 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2325 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2326 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2327 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2328 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2329 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2330 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2331 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2332 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2333 bufsize.
2334
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002335tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2336 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2337 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2338 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2339 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2340 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2341 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2342 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2343 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2344 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002345 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2346 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002347 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2348 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2349 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2350 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2351 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2352 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2353 setting this parameter to 0.
2354
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002355tune.pipesize <number>
2356 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2357 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2358 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2359 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2360 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2361 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2362
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002363tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2364 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2365 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2366 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2367 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2368 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2369 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002370 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002371
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002372tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2373 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2374 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2375 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2376 default is 20.
2377
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002378tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2379tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2380 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2381 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2382 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002383 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002384 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002385 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2386 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2387
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002388tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002389 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002390 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2391 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2392 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2393 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2394
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002395tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002396 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002397 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002398 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2399 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2400 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2401
2402tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2403 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2404 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2405 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2406 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2407 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2408 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2409 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2410 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2411 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002412
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002413tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2414tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2415 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2416 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2417 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002418 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002419 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002420 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2421 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2422 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2423 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2424 notifying haproxy again.
2425
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002426tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002427 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2428 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2429 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002430 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002431 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002432 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002433 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2434 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2435 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002436 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2437 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002438
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002439tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002440 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002441 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2442 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2443 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2444 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2445 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2446
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002447tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2448 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2449 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2450 performances. This is disabled by default.
2451
2452 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2453 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2454
2455 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2456
2457 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2458
2459 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2460
2461 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2462 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2463 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2464
2465 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2466 converted.
2467
2468 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2469 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2470 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2471 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2472 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2473 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2474 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002475 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2476 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002477
2478 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2479
2480 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2481 only need this line:
2482
2483 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2484
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002485tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2486 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002487 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002488 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2489 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2490 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2491 being used for too long.
2492
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002493tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2494 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2495 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2496 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2497 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2498 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2499 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2500 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2501 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2502 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2503 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002504 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002505 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002506
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002507tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2508 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2509 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2510 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2511 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002512 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002513 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2514 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002515 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2516 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002517
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002518tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2519 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2520 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2521 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2522 1000 entries.
2523
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002524tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2525 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2526 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2527 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2528
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002529tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002530tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002531tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2532tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2533tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002534 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2535 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2536 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2537 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2538 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2539 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2540 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2541 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002542
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002543 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2544 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2545 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2546 all available space is consumed.
2547 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2548 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2549 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002550
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002551tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2552 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002553 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002554 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002555 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002556 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2557
2558tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2559 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2560 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002561 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2562 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025643.3. Debugging
2565--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002566
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002567quiet
2568 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2569 line argument "-q".
2570
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002571zero-warning
2572 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2573 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2574 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2575 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2576 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2577 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2578
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002579
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010025803.4. Userlists
2581--------------
2582It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2583http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2584it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2585
2586userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002587 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002588 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2589
2590group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002591 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002592 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2593 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2594
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002595user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2596 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002597 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2598 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002599 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2600 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2601 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2602 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002603
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002604 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2605 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2606 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2607 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2608 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2609 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2610 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2611 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2612 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002613
2614 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002615 userlist L1
2616 group G1 users tiger,scott
2617 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002618
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002619 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2620 user scott insecure-password elgato
2621 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002622
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002623 userlist L2
2624 group G1
2625 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002626
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002627 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2628 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2629 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002630
2631 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002632
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002633
26343.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002635----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002636It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2637several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2638instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2639values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2640automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2641In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2642using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2643tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2644reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2645Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2646that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2647each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002648
2649peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002650 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002651 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2652
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002653bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2654 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2655 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2656
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002657disabled
2658 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2659 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2660 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2661
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002662default-bind [param*]
2663 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2664
2665default-server [param*]
2666 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2667
2668 Arguments:
2669 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2670 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2671 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2672 details.
2673
2674
2675 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2676
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002677enable
2678 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2679
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002680log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2681 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2682 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2683 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2684 more details.
2685
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002686peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002687 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2688 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002689 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2690 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2691 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2692 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2693 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002694
2695 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2696 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2697
2698 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002699 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2700 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2701 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002702
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002703 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2704 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002705
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002706 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2707 "server" keyword explanation below).
2708
2709server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002710 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002711 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2712 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2713 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2714 of this "peers" section).
2715 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2716
2717
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002718 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002719 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002720 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002721 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2722 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2723 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002724
2725 backend mybackend
2726 mode tcp
2727 balance roundrobin
2728 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2729 stick on src
2730
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002731 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2732 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002733
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002734 Example:
2735 peers mypeers
2736 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2737 default-server ssl verify none
2738 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2739 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002740
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002741
2742table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2743 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2744
2745 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2746 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002747 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002748 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2749 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2750 "stick-table" keyword).
2751
2752 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2753 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2754 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2755 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2756 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2757 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2758 of the stick-table name as follows:
2759
2760 peers mypeers
2761 peer A ...
2762 peer B ...
2763 table t1 ...
2764
2765 frontend fe1
2766 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2767
2768 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2769 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2770
2771 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2772 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2773 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2774 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2775 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2776 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2777 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2778
2779 peers mypeers
2780 peer A ...
2781 peer B ...
2782 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2783
2784 backend t1
2785 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2786
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002787 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002788 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2789 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2790
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090027913.6. Mailers
2792------------
2793It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2794If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2795in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2796
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002797mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002798 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2799 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2800
2801mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2802 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2803
2804 Example:
2805 mailers mymailers
2806 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2807 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2808
2809 backend mybackend
2810 mode tcp
2811 balance roundrobin
2812
2813 email-alert mailers mymailers
2814 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2815 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2816
2817 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2818 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2819
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002820timeout mail <time>
2821 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2822 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2823 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2824 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2825
2826 Example:
2827 mailers mymailers
2828 timeout mail 20s
2829 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002830
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028313.7. Programs
2832-------------
2833In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2834master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2835managed the same way as the workers.
2836
2837During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2838sequence as a worker:
2839
2840 - the master is re-executed
2841 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2842 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2843 instance of the program
2844
2845During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2846
2847program <name>
2848 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2849 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2850 the management guide).
2851
2852command <command> [arguments*]
2853 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2854 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2855 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2856 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2857
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002858user <user name>
2859 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2860 See also "group".
2861
2862group <group name>
2863 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2864 See also "user".
2865
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002866option start-on-reload
2867no option start-on-reload
2868 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2869 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2870 program section.
2871
2872
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028733.8. HTTP-errors
2874----------------
2875
2876It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2877imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2878several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2879
2880http-errors <name>
2881 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2882 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2883
2884errorfile <code> <file>
2885 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2886
2887 Arguments :
2888 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002889 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2890 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002891
2892 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2893 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2894 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2895 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2896 before any chroot is performed.
2897
2898 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2899
2900 Example:
2901 http-errors website-1
2902 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2903 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2904 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2905
2906 http-errors website-2
2907 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2908 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2909 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2910
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029113.9. Rings
2912----------
2913
2914It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2915servers or traces.
2916
2917ring <ringname>
2918 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2919
2920description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002921 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002922 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2923
2924format <format>
2925 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2926
2927 Arguments:
2928 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2929 one of the following :
2930
2931 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2932 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2933 designed to be used with a local log server.
2934
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002935 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
2936 field is stripped. This is the default.
2937 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
2938 rfc3164.
2939
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002940 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2941 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2942 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2943 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2944 is the default.
2945
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002946 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002947 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2948
2949 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2950 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2951
2952 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2953 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2954 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2955 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2956 logger consumes.
2957
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002958 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2959 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2960 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2961 with a local log server.
2962
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002963 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2964 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2965 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2966 used with a local log server.
2967
2968maxlen <length>
2969 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2970 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2971 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2972
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002973server <name> <address> [param*]
2974 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2975 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2976 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2977 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2978 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2979 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2980 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2981 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2982 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002983 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2984 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002985
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002986size <size>
2987 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2988 set to BUFSIZE.
2989
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002990timeout connect <timeout>
2991 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2992
2993 Arguments :
2994 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2995 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2996 as explained at the top of this document.
2997
2998timeout server <timeout>
2999 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3000
3001 Arguments :
3002 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3003 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3004 as explained at the top of this document.
3005
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003006 Example:
3007 global
3008 log ring@myring local7
3009
3010 ring myring
3011 description "My local buffer"
3012 format rfc3164
3013 maxlen 1200
3014 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003015 timeout connect 5s
3016 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003017 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003018
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030193.10. Log forwarding
3020-------------------
3021
3022It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3023haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3024
3025log-forward <name>
3026 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3027
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003028backlog <conns>
3029 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3030 on connections accept.
3031
3032bind <addr> [param*]
3033 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003034 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3035 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3036 syslog protocol over TCP.
3037 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003038 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3039
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003040dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003041 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3042 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3043 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3044 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003045 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003046
3047log global
3048log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
3049 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3050 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3051 documentation.
3052 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3053 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3054 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3055 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3056 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3057
3058 Example:
3059 global
3060 log stderr format iso local7
3061
3062 ring myring
3063 description "My local buffer"
3064 format rfc5424
3065 maxlen 1200
3066 size 32764
3067 timeout connect 5s
3068 timeout server 10s
3069 # syslog tcp server
3070 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3071
3072 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003073 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3074 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003075 # all messages on stderr
3076 log global
3077 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3078 log ring@myring local0
3079 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3080 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3081 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3082 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3083 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003084
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003085maxconn <conns>
3086 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3087 10 is the default.
3088
3089timeout client <timeout>
3090 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030924. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003093----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003095Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02003096 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003097 - frontend <name>
3098 - backend <name>
3099 - listen <name>
3100
3101A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
3102its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
3103section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003104section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003105
3106A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3107connections.
3108
3109A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3110to forward incoming connections.
3111
3112A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3113parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3114
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003115All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3116'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3117case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3118
3119Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3120logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3121proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3122However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3123name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3124
3125Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3126and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003127bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3129modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3130arbitrary criteria.
3131
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003132In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3133a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003134the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003135
3136 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3137 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3138 between responses and new requests.
3139
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003140 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3141 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3142 client-facing connection remains open.
3143
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003144 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3145 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003146
3147The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3148frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3149following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003150weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003151
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003152 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003153
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003154 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3155 ----+-----+-----+----
3156 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3157 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003158 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3159 ----+-----+-----+----
3160 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003161
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031644.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3165--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003167The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3168limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3169they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3170limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003171marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003172option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003173and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3174with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3175specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003177
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003178 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3179------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3180acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003181backlog X X X -
3182balance X - X X
3183bind - X X -
3184bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003185capture cookie - X X -
3186capture request header - X X -
3187capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003188clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3189clitcpka-idle X X X -
3190clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003191compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003192cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003193declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003194default-server X - X X
3195default_backend X X X -
3196description - X X X
3197disabled X X X X
3198dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003199email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003200email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003201email-alert mailers X X X X
3202email-alert myhostname X X X X
3203email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003204enabled X X X X
3205errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003206errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003207errorloc X X X X
3208errorloc302 X X X X
3209-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3210errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003211force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003212filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003213fullconn X - X X
3214grace X X X X
3215hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003216http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003217http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003218http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003219http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003220http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003221http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003222http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003223http-check set-var X - X X
3224http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003225http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003226http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003227http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003228http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003229http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003230id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003231ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003232load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003233log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003234log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003235log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003236log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003237max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003238maxconn X X X -
3239mode X X X X
3240monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003241monitor-uri X X X -
3242option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3243option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3244option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3245option allbackups (*) X - X X
3246option checkcache (*) X - X X
3247option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3248option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003249option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003250option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3251option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003252-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3253option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003254option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3255option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003256option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003257option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003258option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003259option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003260option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003261option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3262option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3263option httpchk X - X X
3264option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003265option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003266option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003267option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003268option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003269option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003270option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3271option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3272option logasap (*) X X X -
3273option mysql-check X - X X
3274option nolinger (*) X X X X
3275option originalto X X X X
3276option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003277option pgsql-check X - X X
3278option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003279option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003280option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003281option smtpchk X - X X
3282option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3283option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3284option splice-request (*) X X X X
3285option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003286option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003287option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3288option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3289-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003290option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003291option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3292option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3293option tcpka X X X X
3294option tcplog X X X X
3295option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003296external-check command X - X X
3297external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003298persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3299rate-limit sessions X X X -
3300redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003302retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003303retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003304server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003305server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003306server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003307source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003308srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3309srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3310srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003311stats admin - X X X
3312stats auth X X X X
3313stats enable X X X X
3314stats hide-version X X X X
3315stats http-request - X X X
3316stats realm X X X X
3317stats refresh X X X X
3318stats scope X X X X
3319stats show-desc X X X X
3320stats show-legends X X X X
3321stats show-node X X X X
3322stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003323-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3324stick match - - X X
3325stick on - - X X
3326stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003327stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003328stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003329tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003330tcp-check connect X - X X
3331tcp-check expect X - X X
3332tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003333tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003334tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003335tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003336tcp-check set-var X - X X
3337tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003338tcp-request connection - X X -
3339tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003340tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003341tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003342tcp-response content - - X X
3343tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003344timeout check X - X X
3345timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003346timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003347timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003348timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3349timeout http-request X X X X
3350timeout queue X - X X
3351timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003352timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003353timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003354timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003355transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003356unique-id-format X X X -
3357unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003358use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003359use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003360use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003361------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3362 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033654.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3366---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367
3368This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3369
3370
3371acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3372 Declare or complete an access list.
3373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3374 no | yes | yes | yes
3375 Example:
3376 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3377 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3378 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003380 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003381
3382
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003383backlog <conns>
3384 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | yes | yes | no
3387 Arguments :
3388 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3389 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003390 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003391
3392 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3393 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3394 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3395 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3396 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3397 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3398 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3399 backlog parameter.
3400
3401 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3402 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3403 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3404
3405 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3406
3407
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003409balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003410 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3412 yes | no | yes | yes
3413 Arguments :
3414 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3415 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3416 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3417 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3418
3419 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3420 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3421 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3422 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003423 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003424 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003425 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3426 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3427 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3428 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3429 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3430 it, so that you don't worry.
3431
3432 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3433 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3434 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3435 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3436 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3437 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3438 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3439 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003440
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003441 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3442 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3443 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3444 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3445 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3446 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3447 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003448 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3449 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3450 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003451
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003452 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003453 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003454 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3455 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003456 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003457 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3458 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3459 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3460 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3461 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003462 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3463 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3464 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3465 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3466 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3467 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003469 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3470 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3471 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3472 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3473 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3474 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3475 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3476 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003477 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003478 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003479 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3480 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3481 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003482
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003483 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3484 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3485 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3486 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3487 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3488 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3489 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3490 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3491 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3492 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3493 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3494 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003495
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003496 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003497 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3498 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3499 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3500 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3501 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3502 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3503 URIs start with a leading "/".
3504
3505 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3506 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3507 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3508 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3509
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003510 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3511 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3512 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3513 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003515 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003516 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3517
3518 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003519 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3520 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003521 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3522 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3523 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3524 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003525 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003526 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3527 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003528
3529 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3530 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3531 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3532 server will receive the request.
3533
3534 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3535 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3536 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3537 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3538 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003539 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3540 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3541 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003542
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003543 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3544 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3545 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3546 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3547 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003549 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003550 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3551 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3552 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3553
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003554 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3555 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3556 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3557
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003558 random
3559 random(<draws>)
3560 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003561 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3562 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3563 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3564 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003565 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3566 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3567 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3568 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3569 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3570 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3571 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3572 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3573 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3574 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3575 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3576 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3577 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3578 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3579 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3580 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3581 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3582 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3583 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3584 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003585
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003586 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003587 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003588 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3589 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3590 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3591 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3592 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3593 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003594 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003595 used instead.
3596
3597 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3598 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3599 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3600 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3601
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003602 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3603 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3604 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3605
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003606 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003607
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003608 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003609 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3610 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003611
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003612 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3613 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3614 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003615
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003616 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003617 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003618 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3619 NTLM relies on.
3620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621 Examples :
3622 balance roundrobin
3623 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003624 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003625 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3626 balance hdr(host)
3627 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003628
3629 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3630 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003632 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003633 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3634 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3635 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003636 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003637
3638 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3639 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3640 defaults to 16 kB.
3641
3642 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3643 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3644
3645 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3646 Round Robin.
3647
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003648 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003649 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3650 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3651 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3652
3653 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3654
3655 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003656 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003657 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3658 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3659 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003660
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003661 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003662
3663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003664bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3665bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003666 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 no | yes | yes | no
3669 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003670 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3671 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3672 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3673 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003674 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003675 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3676 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3677 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3678 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3679 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3680 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003681 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003682 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3683 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003684 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003685 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3686 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003687 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003688 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3689 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003690 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003691 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3692 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3693 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3694 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3695 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3696 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3697 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003698 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3699 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3700 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003701 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3702 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3703 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3704 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003705 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3706 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3707 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003708
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003709 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3710 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003711 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3712 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3713 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003714 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3715 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3716 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3717 the range.
3718
3719 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3720 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3721 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3722 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3723 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3724 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3725 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003726 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003727 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003728
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003729 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003730 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003731 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3732 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3733 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3734 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3735 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3736 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003738 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3739 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3740 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3741 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003743 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3744 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3745 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3746 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3747 in a frontend.
3748
3749 Example :
3750 listen http_proxy
3751 bind :80,:443
3752 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003753 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003755 listen http_https_proxy
3756 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003757 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003758
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003759 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3760 bind ipv6@:80
3761 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3762 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3763
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003764 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003765 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003766
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003767 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3768 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3769 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3770 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3771 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3772
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003773 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003774 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003775
3776
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003777bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003778 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3780 yes | yes | yes | yes
3781 Arguments :
3782 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3783 may be used to override a default value.
3784
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003785 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003786 option may be combined with other numbers.
3787
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003788 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003789 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3790 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3791 missing from all processes.
3792
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003793 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003794 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003795 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3796 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3797 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3798 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3799 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003800 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003801
3802 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3803 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3804 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3805 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3806 and 'even' instances.
3807
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003808 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3809 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3810 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3811 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003812
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003813 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3814 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3815
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003816 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3817 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3818 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3819
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003820 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3821 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3822
3823 Example :
3824 listen app_ip1
3825 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003826 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003827
3828 listen app_ip2
3829 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003830 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003831
3832 listen management
3833 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003834 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003835
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003836 listen management
3837 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3838 bind-process 1-4
3839
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003840 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003841
3842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003843capture cookie <name> len <length>
3844 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3846 no | yes | yes | no
3847 Arguments :
3848 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3849 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3850 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3851 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003852 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003853
3854 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3855 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3856 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3857 right if it exceeds <length>.
3858
3859 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3860 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3861 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3862 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3863
3864 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3865 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3866 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3867
3868 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3869 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3870 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003871 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3872 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3873 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003874
3875 Example:
3876 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3877
3878 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003879 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003880
3881
3882capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003883 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3885 no | yes | yes | no
3886 Arguments :
3887 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003888 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003889 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3890 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3891 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3892
3893 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3894 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3895 it exceeds <length>.
3896
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003897 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003898 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3899 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003900 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3901 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3902 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3903 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003904 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003905 environments to find where the request came from.
3906
3907 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3908 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3909 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3910 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003911
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003912 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3913 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3914 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3915 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3916 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003917
3918 Example:
3919 capture request header Host len 15
3920 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003921 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003922
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003923 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003924 about logging.
3925
3926
3927capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003928 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3930 no | yes | yes | no
3931 Arguments :
3932 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003933 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3935 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3936 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3937
3938 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3939 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3940 it exceeds <length>.
3941
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003942 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003943 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3944 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3945 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003946 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3947 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3948 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3949 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003950
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003951 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3952 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3953 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3954 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3955 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003956
3957 Example:
3958 capture response header Content-length len 9
3959 capture response header Location len 15
3960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003961 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003962 about logging.
3963
3964
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003965clitcpka-cnt <count>
3966 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3967 the connection on the client side.
3968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3969 yes | yes | yes | no
3970 Arguments :
3971 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3972
3973 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3974 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003975 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3976 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003977
3978 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3979
3980
3981clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3982 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3983 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3984 client side.
3985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3986 yes | yes | yes | no
3987 Arguments :
3988 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3989 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3990 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3991 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3992
3993 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3994 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003995 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3996 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003997
3998 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3999
4000
4001clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4002 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4004 yes | yes | yes | no
4005 Arguments :
4006 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4007 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4008 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4009 document.
4010
4011 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4012 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004013 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4014 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004015
4016 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4017
4018
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004019compression algo <algorithm> ...
4020compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004021compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004022 Enable HTTP compression.
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | yes | yes | yes
4025 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004026 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4027 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4028 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4029
4030 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004031 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4032 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4033 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004034
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004035 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004036 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004037
4038 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4039 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4040 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4041 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4042 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004043 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004044
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004045 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4046 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4047 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4048 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4049 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4050 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4051 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004052 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004053
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004054 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004055 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004056 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4057 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4058 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4059 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4060 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004061
4062 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4063 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4064 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4065 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4066 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004067 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4068 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4069 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4070 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4071 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004072 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4073 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004074
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004075 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004076 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4077 "Accept-Encoding" header
4078 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004079 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004080 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4081 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4082 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4083 "multipart"
4084 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4085 header
4086 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4087 and later
4088 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4089 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004090 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004091
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004092 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004093
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004094 Examples :
4095 compression algo gzip
4096 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004097
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004098
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004099cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004100 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4101 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004102 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004103 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4105 yes | no | yes | yes
4106 Arguments :
4107 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4108 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4109 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4110 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4111 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4112 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004113 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004114 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4115 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4116
4117 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4118 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4119 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4120 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4121 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4122 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004123 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4124 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004125 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004126 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4127 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004128
4129 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004130 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004131
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004132 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004133 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004134 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004135 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004136 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4137 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4138 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4139 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4140 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4141 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4142 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004143
4144 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4145 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4146 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4147 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4148 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4149 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4150 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4151 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4152 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004153 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004154 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4155 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4156 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004157
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004158 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4159 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4160 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004161 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4162 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4163 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4164 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004165 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4166 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4167 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168
4169 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4170 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4171 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4172 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4173 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4174 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4175 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4176 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4177 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4178
4179 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4180 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4181 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4182 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4183 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4184 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4185 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4186 persistence cookie in the cache.
4187 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4188
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004189 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4190 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4191 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4192 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4193 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004194 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004195 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4196 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4197 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4198 they logout.
4199
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004200 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4201 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4202 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4203 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4204
4205 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4206 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4207 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4208 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4209 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4210 this attribute.
4211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004212 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004213 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004214 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4215 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4216 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4217 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4218 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4219 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004220
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004221 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4222 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4223 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4224 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4225 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4226 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4227 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4228 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004229 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004230 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4231 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4232 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4233 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4234 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4235 the site.
4236
4237 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4238 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4239 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4240 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4241 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4242 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4243 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4244 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4245 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4246 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4247 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4248 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4249 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004250 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004251 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4252 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4253
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004254 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4255 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4256 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4257 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4258 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4259 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4260
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004261 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4262 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4263 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4264 repeated.
4265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004266 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4267 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4268 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4269 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004271 Examples :
4272 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4273 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4274 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004275 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004276
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004277 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004279
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004280declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4281 Declares a capture slot.
4282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | no
4284 Arguments:
4285 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4286
4287 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4288 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4289 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4290 for use in the response.
4291
4292 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004293 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004294 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4295
4296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004297default-server [param*]
4298 Change default options for a server in a backend
4299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4300 yes | no | yes | yes
4301 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004302 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4303 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4304 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4305 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004306
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004307 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004308 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4309
4310 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004311
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004312
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004313default_backend <backend>
4314 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4316 yes | yes | yes | no
4317 Arguments :
4318 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4319
4320 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4321 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4322 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4323 will catch all undetermined requests.
4324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004325 Example :
4326
4327 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4328 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4329 default_backend dynamic
4330
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004331 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004332
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004333
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004334description <string>
4335 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4337 no | yes | yes | yes
4338 Arguments : string
4339
4340 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4341 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4342 it describes.
4343 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4344
4345
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004346disabled
4347 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4349 yes | yes | yes | yes
4350 Arguments : none
4351
4352 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4353 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4354 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4355 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4356 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4357 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4358 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4359
4360 See also : "enabled"
4361
4362
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004363dispatch <address>:<port>
4364 Set a default server address
4365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4366 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004367 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004368
4369 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4370 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4371 during start-up.
4372
4373 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4374 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4375 possible with normal servers.
4376
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004377 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004378 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4379 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4380 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4381 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4382
4383 See also : "server"
4384
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004385
4386dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4387 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4389 yes | no | yes | yes
4390 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4391
4392 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004393 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004394 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4395 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004396 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004397 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004399enabled
4400 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | yes | yes | yes
4403 Arguments : none
4404
4405 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4406 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4407
4408 See also : "disabled"
4409
4410
4411errorfile <code> <file>
4412 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4414 yes | yes | yes | yes
4415 Arguments :
4416 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004417 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004418 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004419
4420 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004421 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004422 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004423 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4424 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004425
4426 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4427 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4428 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4429
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004430 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4431
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004432 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4433 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4434 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4435 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4436 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4437 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4438 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4439 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4440 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004441
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004442 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4443 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4444 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004445 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004446 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4447
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004448 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004449
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004450 Example :
4451 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004452 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004453 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4454 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4455
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004456
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004457errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4458 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4459 section.
4460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4461 yes | yes | yes | yes
4462 Arguments :
4463 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4464
4465 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004466 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004467 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004468
4469 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4470 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4471 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4472 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4473 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004474 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004475 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4476
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004477 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4478 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004479
4480 Example :
4481 errorfiles generic
4482 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4483
4484
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004485errorloc <code> <url>
4486errorloc302 <code> <url>
4487 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4489 yes | yes | yes | yes
4490 Arguments :
4491 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004492 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004493 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004494
4495 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4496 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4497 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4498 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004499 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004500
4501 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4502 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4503 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4504
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004505 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4506
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004507 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4508 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4509 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4510 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004511 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004512 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4513 request.
4514
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004515 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004516
4517
4518errorloc303 <code> <url>
4519 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4521 yes | yes | yes | yes
4522 Arguments :
4523 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004524 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004525 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004526
4527 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4528 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4529 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4530 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004531 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004532
4533 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4534 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4535 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4536
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004537 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4538
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004539 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4540 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4541 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4542 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004543 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004544
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004545 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004546
4547
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004548email-alert from <emailaddr>
4549 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004550 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004551 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4552 yes | yes | yes | yes
4553
4554 Arguments :
4555
4556 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4557
4558 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4559 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4560
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004561 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004562 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4563 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004564
4565
4566email-alert level <level>
4567 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4568 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4570 yes | yes | yes | yes
4571
4572 Arguments :
4573
4574 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4575 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4576 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4577
4578 By default level is alert
4579
4580 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4581 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4582 for the proxy.
4583
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004584 Alerts are sent when :
4585
4586 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4587 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4588 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4589 is notice or lower
4590 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4591 and a health check status update occurs
4592
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004593 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4594 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004595 section 3.6 about mailers.
4596
4597
4598email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4599 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4600 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4601 yes | yes | yes | yes
4602
4603 Arguments :
4604
4605 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4606
4607 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4608 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4609
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004610 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4611 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004612
4613
4614email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4615 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4616 mailers.
4617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | yes | yes | yes
4619
4620 Arguments :
4621
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004622 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004623
4624 By default the systems hostname is used.
4625
4626 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4627 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4628 for the proxy.
4629
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004630 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4631 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004632
4633
4634email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004635 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004636 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4637 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4638 yes | yes | yes | yes
4639
4640 Arguments :
4641
4642 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4643
4644 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4645 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4646
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004647 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004648 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4649
4650
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004651force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4652 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004654 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004655
4656 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4657 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4658 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4659 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4660 marked down for maintenance operations.
4661
4662 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4663 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4664 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4665 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4666 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4667 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4668 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4669 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4670 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4671
4672 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4673 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4674 is used.
4675
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004676 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004677 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004678
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004679
4680filter <name> [param*]
4681 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4683 no | yes | yes | yes
4684 Arguments :
4685 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4686 referenced in section 9.
4687
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004688 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004689 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004690 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4691 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004692
4693 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4694 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4695
4696 Example:
4697 listen
4698 bind *:80
4699
4700 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4701 filter compression
4702 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4703
4704 compression algo gzip
4705 compression offload
4706
4707 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4708
4709 See also : section 9.
4710
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004711
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004712fullconn <conns>
4713 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4715 yes | no | yes | yes
4716 Arguments :
4717 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4718 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4719
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004720 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004721 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004722 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004723 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4724 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4725 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4726 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4727 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004728 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004729
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004730 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4731 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004732 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4733 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4734 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004735
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004736 Example :
4737 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4738 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4739 # connections.
4740 backend dynamic
4741 fullconn 10000
4742 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4743 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4744
4745 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4746
4747
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004748grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004749 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004751 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004752 Arguments :
4753 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4754 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4755 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4756
4757 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4758 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004759 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004760 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4761
4762 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4763 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4764 simplify it.
4765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004766
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004767hash-balance-factor <factor>
4768 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4770 yes | no | no | yes
4771 Arguments :
4772 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4773 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004774 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004775
4776 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4777 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4778 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4779 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4780 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4781 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4782 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4783
4784 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4785 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4786 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4787 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4788 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4789
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004790 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4791 consistent hashing mechanism.
4792
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004793 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4794
4795
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004796hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004797 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4799 yes | no | yes | yes
4800 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004801 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4802 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004803
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004804 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4805 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4806 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4807 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4808 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4809 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4810 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4811 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4812 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4813 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004814
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004815 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4816 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4817 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4818 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4819 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4820 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4821 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4822 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4823 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4824 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4825 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4826 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4827 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004828 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4829 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004830
4831 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4832
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004833 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004834 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4835 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4836 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004837 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4838 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4839 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004840
4841 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4842 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004843 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4844 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4845 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4846 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4847
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004848 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4849 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4850 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4851 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4852 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4853 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4854 parameter.
4855
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004856 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4857 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4858 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4859 used on strings.
4860
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004861 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4862
4863 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4864 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4865 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4866 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4867 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4868 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4869 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4870 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4871 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4872 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4873 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4874 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004875
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004876 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4877 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4878 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004879
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004880 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004881
4882
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004883http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4884 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4885 ones).
4886
4887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 no | yes | yes | yes
4889
4890 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4891 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4892 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4893 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4894 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4895 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4896
4897 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4898 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4899 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4900
4901 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4902 below.
4903
4904 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4905 instance.
4906
4907 Example:
4908 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4909 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4910 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4911
4912http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4913
4914 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4915 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4916 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4917 example, or to pass some internal information.
4918 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4919 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4920 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4921
4922http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4923
4924 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4925 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4926
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004927http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004928
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004929 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4930 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4931 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4932 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4933 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004934
4935http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4936 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4937
4938 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4939
4940 Example:
4941 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4942
4943 # applied to:
4944 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4945
4946 # outputs:
4947 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4948
4949 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4950
4951http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4952 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4953
4954 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4955
4956 Example:
4957 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4958
4959 # applied to:
4960 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4961
4962 # outputs:
4963 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4964
4965http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4966
4967 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4968 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4969 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4970
4971http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4972 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4973
4974 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4975 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4976 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4977 fallback.
4978
4979 Example:
4980 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4981 http-response set-status 431
4982 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4983 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4984
4985http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4986
4987 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4988 inline.
4989
4990 Arguments:
4991 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4992 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4993 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4994 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4995 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4996 (request and response)
4997 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4998 processing
4999 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5000 processing
5001 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5002 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5003 and '_'.
5004
5005 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5006 followed by some converters.
5007
5008 Example:
5009 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5010
5011http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5012
5013 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5014 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5015 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5016 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5017 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005018 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005019 processing.
5020
5021 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5022 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005023 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005024 rules evaluation.
5025
5026http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5027
5028 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5029 details about <var-name>.
5030
5031 Example:
5032 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5033
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005034
5035http-check comment <string>
5036 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5037 it fails.
5038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 yes | no | yes | yes
5040
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005041 Arguments :
5042 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5043 rule fails.
5044
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005045 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5046 user-friendly error reporting.
5047
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005048 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005049 "http-check expect".
5050
5051
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005052http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5053 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005054 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005055 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5057 yes | no | yes | yes
5058
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005059 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005060 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5061
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005062 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005063 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005064
5065 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5066 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5067 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5068 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5069
5070 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5071
5072 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5073
5074 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5075
5076 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5077
5078 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5079
5080 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5081 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5082 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5083 is used.
5084
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005085 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5086 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5087 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5088 haproxy -vv.
5089
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005090 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5091
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005092 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5093 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5094 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5095 different ports or with different servers.
5096
5097 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5098 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5099 the port with a "http-check connect".
5100
5101 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5102 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5103 do.
5104
5105 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5106 unset-var or comment rules.
5107
5108 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005109 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5110 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5111 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5112 option httpchk
5113
5114 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005115 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005116 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005117 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005118 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005119 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005120
5121 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5122
5123 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005124
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005126http-check disable-on-404
5127 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005129 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005130 Arguments : none
5131
5132 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5133 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5134 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5135 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5136 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5137 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5138 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5139 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005140 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5141 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005142 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5143 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5144 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005145
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005146 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005147
5148
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005149http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005150 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5151 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5152 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005153 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005155 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005156
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005157 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005158 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5159
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005160 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5161 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5162 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5163 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5164 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5165 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5166 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5167 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5168 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5169 result is always conclusive.
5170
5171 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5172 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5173 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005174 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5175 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005176 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5177 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005178 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5179 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5180 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005181
5182 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5183 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005184 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5185 supported :
5186 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5187 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005188 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5189 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5190 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5191 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5192 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005193
5194 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5195 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005196 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5197 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5198 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5199 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005200 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5201
5202 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5203 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5204 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5205 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5206
5207 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5208 informational message reported in logs if an error
5209 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5210 log-format string.
5211
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005212 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005213 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5214 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005215 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5216 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5217 details on the supported keywords.
5218
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005219 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5220 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5221 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5222 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005223
5224 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5225 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5226 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5227 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5228 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5229
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005230 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5231 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5232 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5233 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5234 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5235 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5236 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005237
5238 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005239 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005240 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5241 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5242 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5243 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5244
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005245 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5246 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005247 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5248 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5249 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5250 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5251 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5252 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5253 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5254 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005255 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5256 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5257 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5258 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5259 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5260 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5261 insensitive on the header names.
5262
5263 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5264 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5265 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5266 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5267 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5268 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005269
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005270 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005271 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005272 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5273 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5274 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5275 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5276 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005277 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005278 trace).
5279
5280 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005281 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005282 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5283 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5284 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5285 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5286 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005287 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005288
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005289 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5290 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5291 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5292 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5293 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5294 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5295
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005296 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005297 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005298 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5299 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5300 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5301 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5302 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5303 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5304
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005305 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5306 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5307 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5308 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5309 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005311 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5312 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5313
5314 Examples :
5315 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005316 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005317
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005318 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5319 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5320
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005321 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005322 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005323
5324 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005325 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005326
5327 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005328 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005329
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005330 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005331 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005332
5333
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005334http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005335 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5336 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005337 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5338 health checks.
5339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5340 yes | no | yes | yes
5341 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005342 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5343
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005344 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5345 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5346 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5347 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5348 to invent non-standard ones.
5349
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005350 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5351 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5352 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5353 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5354
5355 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5356 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5357 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5358 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005359
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005360 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005361 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005362 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005363 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5364 to add it.
5365
5366 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5367 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5368 to the log-format rules.
5369
5370 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5371 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5372 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005373
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005374 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5375 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5376 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5377 request.
5378
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005379 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5380 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5381 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005382 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5383 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5384 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5385 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005386 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005387 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005388 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5389
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005390 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5391 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005392 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5393 so, it will be ignored.
5394
5395 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5396 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5397 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5398 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5399 configured request authority.
5400
5401 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5402 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005403
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005404 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005405
5406
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005407http-check send-state
5408 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5410 yes | no | yes | yes
5411 Arguments : none
5412
5413 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5414 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5415 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5416 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5417 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5418
5419 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5420 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5421 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5422 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5423 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005424 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5425 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5426 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5427
5428 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5429 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5430 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5431
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005432 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5433 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5434 checked in multiple backends.
5435
5436 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5437 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5438
5439 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5440 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5441 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5442 one fails.
5443
5444 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5445 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5446 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5447
5448 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5449 server's queue.
5450
5451 Example of a header received by the application server :
5452 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5453 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5454
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005455 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5456 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005457
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458
5459http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005460 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005461 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5462 yes | no | yes | yes
5463
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005464 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005465 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5466 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5467 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5468 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5469 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5470 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5471 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5472 and '-'.
5473
5474 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5475
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005476 Examples :
5477 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005478
5479
5480http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005481 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5483 yes | no | yes | yes
5484
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005485 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005486 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5487 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5488 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5489 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5490 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5491 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5492 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5493 and '-'.
5494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005495 Examples :
5496 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005498
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005499http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5500 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5501 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5502 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5503 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5505 yes | yes | yes | yes
5506 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005507 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005508 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005509 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5510 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005511
5512 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5513 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5514 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5515 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5516
5517 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5518 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5519 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5520 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5521
5522 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5523 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5524 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5525 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5526 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5527 chroot is performed.
5528
5529 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5530 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5531 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5532 considered.
5533
5534 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5535 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5536 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5537 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5538 considered as a raw string.
5539
5540 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5541 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5542 "content-type".
5543
5544 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5545 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5546 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5547 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5548 evaluated as a log-format string.
5549
5550 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5551 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5552 argument to "content-type".
5553
5554 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5555 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5556 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5557 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5558
5559 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5560 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5561 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5562 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5563 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5564 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5565 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5566 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5567
5568 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5569 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5570 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5571
5572 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5573 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5574
5575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005576http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005577 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5578
5579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5580 no | yes | yes | yes
5581
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005582 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5583 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5584 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5585 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5586 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005588 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5589 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005591 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005593 Example:
5594 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5595 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5596 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005598 http-request allow if nagios
5599 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5600 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5601 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005603 Example:
5604 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5605 acl add path /addacl
5606 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005608 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005609
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005610 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5611 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005613 Example:
5614 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5615 acl setmap path /setmap
5616 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005618 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005620 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5621 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005623 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5624 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005626http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005628 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5629 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5630 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5631 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5632 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5633 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5634 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5635 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005637http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005639 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5640 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5641 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5642 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5643 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5644 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5645 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5646 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005648http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005650 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5651 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005652
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005654http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005656 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5657 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5658 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5659 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5660 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005661
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005662 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5663 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5664 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5665 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5666 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5667 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5668 instead.
5669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005670 Example:
5671 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5672 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005673
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005674http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005675
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005676 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005678http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5679 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005681 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5682 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5683 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5684 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5685 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5686 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5687 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5688 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5689 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005691 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5692 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5693 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005694 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5695
5696 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5697 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5698 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5699 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005701http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005703 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5704 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5705 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5706 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5707 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5708 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005709
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005710http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005711
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005712 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5713 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5714 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5715 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5716 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005718http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005720 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5721 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5722 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5723 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5724 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5725 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005726
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005727http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5728http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5729 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5730 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5731 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5732 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005733
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005734 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5735 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5736 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005737 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005738 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5739 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5740 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005741 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005742 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005743
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005744http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5745 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5746 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5747 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5748
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005749http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5750
5751 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5752 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5753 pointed by <resolvers>.
5754 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5755 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5756 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5757 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5758 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5759 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5760 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5761 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5762 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5763 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5764 to 0.0.0.0.
5765
5766 Example:
5767 resolvers mydns
5768 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5769 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5770 timeout retry 1s
5771 hold valid 10s
5772 hold nx 3s
5773 hold other 3s
5774 hold obsolete 0s
5775 accepted_payload_size 8192
5776
5777 frontend fe
5778 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5779 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5780 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5781
5782 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5783 # which mean DNS resolution error
5784 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5785
5786 default_backend be
5787
5788 backend b_503
5789 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5790 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5791 # 503 error page to end users
5792
5793 backend be
5794 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5795 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5796 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5797 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5798 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5799
5800 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5801 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5802
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005803http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5804
5805 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5806 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5807 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5808 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005809 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5810 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005811
5812 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5813
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005814http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005815
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005816 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5817 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5818 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5819 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5820 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005822http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005824 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5825 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5826 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5827 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005829http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5830 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005831
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005832 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005833 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5834 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5835 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5836 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5837 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005838
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005839 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5840 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5841 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5842 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5843 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005844
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005845 Example:
5846 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5847
5848 # applied to:
5849 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5850
5851 # outputs:
5852 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5853
5854 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005855
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005856 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5857
5858 # applied to:
5859 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005860
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005861 # outputs:
5862 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005863
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005864http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5865 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5866
5867 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5868 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005869 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5870 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5871 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005872
5873 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5874 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5875 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5876
5877 Example:
5878 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5879 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5880
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005881 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5882 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5883 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5884 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5885
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005886http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5887 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5888
5889 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5890 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5891 query-string are replaced.
5892
5893 Example:
5894 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5895 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5896
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005897http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5898 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5899
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005900 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5901 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5902 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5903 against.
5904
5905 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5906 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5907 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005908
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005909 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5910 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5911 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5912 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5913 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5914 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5915 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5916 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5917 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005918 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5919 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005920
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005921 Example:
5922 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5923 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005924
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005925 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5926 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005928http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5929 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005930
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005931 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5932 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5933 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5934 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005935
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005936 Example:
5937 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005938
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005939 # applied to:
5940 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005941
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005942 # outputs:
5943 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005944
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005945http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5946 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5947 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005948 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005949 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5950
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005951 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005952 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5953 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005954 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005955 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005956 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005957 are followed to create the response :
5958
5959 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5960 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5961 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5962 ignored.
5963
5964 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5965 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005966 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005967 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5968 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005969
5970 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5971 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5972 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005973 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005974 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005975
5976 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5977 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5978 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005979 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005980 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5981 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005982
5983 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5984 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5985 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5986 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5987 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5988 as a raw content.
5989
5990 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5991 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5992 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5993 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5994 considered as a raw string.
5995
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005996 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005997 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5998 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5999 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6000
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006001 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6002 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006003 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006004
6005 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6006
6007 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006008 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006009 if { path /ping }
6010
6011 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6012 if { path /favicon.ico }
6013
6014 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6015 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6016 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006018http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6019http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6022 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6023 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006024
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006025http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6026 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006027
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006028 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6029 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6030 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6031 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006033http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006035 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6036 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6037 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6038 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6039 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006041 Arguments:
6042 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6043 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006045 Example:
6046 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6047 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006049 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6050 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006052http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6055 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6056 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006058 Arguments:
6059 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6060 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006062 Example:
6063 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6064 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006065
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006066 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6067 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6068 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006070http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006072 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6073 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6074 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6075 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6076 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006078 Example:
6079 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6080 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6081 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6082 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6083 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6084 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6085 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6086 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6087 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006091 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6092 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6093 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6094 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6095 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6098 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006100 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6101 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6102 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6103 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6104 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6105 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6106 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6107 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6108 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006110http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6113 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6114 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6115 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6116 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6117 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6118 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006120http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006122 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6123 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6124 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006126http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006128 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6129 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6130 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6131 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6132 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6133 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6134 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6135 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006137http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006139 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6140 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6141 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6142 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6143 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6144 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006146 Example :
6147 # prepend the host name before the path
6148 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006149
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006150http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6151
6152 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6153 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6154 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006156http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006158 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6159 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6160 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6161 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6162 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006163
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006164http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006165
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006166 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6167 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6168 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6169 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6170 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6171 values have higher priority.
6172 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6173 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6174 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6175 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6176 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006178http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006180 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6181 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6182 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6183 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6184 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6185 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6186 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006188 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006189
6190 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006191 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6192 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006194http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6195 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6196 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6197 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006198 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6199 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006200
6201 Arguments :
6202 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6203 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006204
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006205 See also "option forwardfor".
6206
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006207 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006208 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6209 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6210
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006211 # After the masking this will track connections
6212 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6213 http-request track-sc0 src
6214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006215 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6216 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6217
6218http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6219
6220 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6221 expression.
6222
6223 Arguments:
6224 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6225 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006226
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006227 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006228 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6229 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6230
6231 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6232 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6233 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6234
6235http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6236
6237 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6238 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6239 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6240 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6241 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6242 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6243 information from the request.
6244
6245 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6246
6247http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6248
6249 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6250 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6251 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6252 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6253 path and the query string.
6254 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6255
6256http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6257
6258 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6259 inline.
6260
6261 Arguments:
6262 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6263 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6264 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6265 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6266 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6267 (request and response)
6268 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6269 processing
6270 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6271 processing
6272 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6273 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6274 and '_'.
6275
6276 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6277 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006278
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006279 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006280 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006282http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6283 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006285 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6286 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6287 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6288 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6289 agent name must be used.
6290
6291 Arguments:
6292 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6293
6294 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6295 configuration.
6296
6297http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6298
6299 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6300 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6301 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6302 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6303 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6304 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6305 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6306 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6307 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6308 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6309 action.
6310 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6311 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6312 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6313 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6314 you fully understand how it works.
6315
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006316http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6317
6318 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6319 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6320 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6321 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6322 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006323 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006324 processing.
6325
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006326 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006327 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6328 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6329 rules evaluation.
6330
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006331http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6332http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6333 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6334 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6335 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6336 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006337
6338 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6339 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6340 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006341 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6342 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6343 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6344 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6345 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6346 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6347 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6348 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6349 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6350 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006351 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006352 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6353 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6354 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6355 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6356 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006357
6358http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6359http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6361
6362 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6363 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6364 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6365 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006366 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006367 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6368 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6369 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6370 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6371 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6372 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6373 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6374
6375 Arguments :
6376 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6377 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6378 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6379 select which table entry to update the counters.
6380
6381 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6382 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6383 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6384 that table until the session ends.
6385
6386 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6387 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6388 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6389 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6390 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6391 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6392 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6393 useful information.
6394
6395 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6396 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6397 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6398 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6399 checks that make use of it.
6400
6401http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6402
6403 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006404
6405 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006406 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006407
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006408http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6409
6410 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6411 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6412 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6413 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6414 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6415 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6416
6417 Arguments :
6418 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6419
6420 Example:
6421 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006423http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006424
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006425 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6426 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6427 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006428
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006429
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006430http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006431 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6432
6433 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6434 no | yes | yes | yes
6435
6436 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6437 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6438 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6439 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6440 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6441 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6442
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006443 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6444 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006445
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006446 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006447
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006448 Example:
6449 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006450
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006451 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006452
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006453 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6454 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006455
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006456 Example:
6457 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006458
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006459 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006460
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006461 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6462 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006464 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6465 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006466
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006467http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006468
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006469 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6470 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6471 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6472 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6473 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6474 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6475 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6476 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006477
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006478http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006479
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006480 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6481 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6482 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6483 example, or to pass some internal information.
6484 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6485 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6486 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006487
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006488http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006489
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006490 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6491 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006492
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006493http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006494
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006495 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006496
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006497http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006498
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006499 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6500 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6501 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6502 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6503 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6504 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6505 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006506
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006507 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6508 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6509 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6510 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6511 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006512
6513 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6514 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6515 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6516 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006517
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006518http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006519
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006520 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6521 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6522 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6523 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6524 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6525 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006526
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006527http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006528
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006529 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6530 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6531 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6532 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6533 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006534
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006535http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006536
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006537 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6538 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6539 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6540 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6541 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6542 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006543
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006544http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6545http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6546 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6547 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6548 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6549 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006550
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006551 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6552 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6553 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006554 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006555 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6556 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6557 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006558 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006559 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006560
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006561http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006562
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006563 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6564 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6565 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6566 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6567 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6568 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006569
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006570http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6571 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006572
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006573 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6574 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006575
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006576 Example:
6577 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006578
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006579 # applied to:
6580 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006581
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006582 # outputs:
6583 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006584
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006585 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006586
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006587http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6588 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006589
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006590 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006591 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006592
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006593 Example:
6594 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006595
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006596 # applied to:
6597 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006598
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006599 # outputs:
6600 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006601
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006602http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6603 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6604 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006605 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006606 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6607
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006608 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006609 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6610 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006611 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006612 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006613 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006614 are followed to create the response :
6615
6616 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6617 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6618 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6619 ignored.
6620
6621 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6622 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006623 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006624 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6625 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006626
6627 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6628 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6629 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006630 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006631 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006632
6633 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6634 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6635 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006636 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006637 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6638 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006639
6640 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6641 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6642 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6643 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6644 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6645 as a raw content.
6646
6647 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6648 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6649 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6650 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6651 considered as a raw string.
6652
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006653 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6654 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6655 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6656 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6657
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006658 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6659 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006660 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006661
6662 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6663
6664 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006665 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006666 if { status eq 404 }
6667
6668 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6669 string "This is the end !" \
6670 if { status eq 500 }
6671
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006672http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6673http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006675 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6676 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6677 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006678
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006679http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6680 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006681
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006682 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6683 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6684 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6685 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006686
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006687http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006688
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006689 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6690 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6691 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6692 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6693 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006694
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006695 Arguments:
6696 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006698 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6699 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006700
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006701http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006702
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006703 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6704 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6705 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006706
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006707http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6708
6709 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6710 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6711 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6712 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6713 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6714
6715http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6716
6717 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6718 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6719 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6720 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6721 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6722 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6723 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6724 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6725 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6726
6727http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6728
6729 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6730 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6731 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6732 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6733 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6734 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6735 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6736
6737http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6738
6739 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6740 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6741 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6742 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6743 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6744 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6745 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6746 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6747
6748http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6749 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6750
6751 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6752 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6753 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6754 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006755
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006756 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006757 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6758 http-response set-status 431
6759 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6760 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006761
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006762http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006763
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006764 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6765 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6766 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6767 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6768 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6769 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6770 based on some information from the request.
6771
6772 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6773
6774http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6775
6776 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6777 inline.
6778
6779 Arguments:
6780 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6781 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6782 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6783 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6784 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6785 (request and response)
6786 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6787 processing
6788 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6789 processing
6790 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6791 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6792 and '_'.
6793
6794 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6795 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006796
6797 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006798 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006799
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006800http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006801
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006802 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6803 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6804 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6805 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6806 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6807 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6808 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6809 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6810 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6811 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6812 action.
6813 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6814 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6815 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6816 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6817 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006818
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006819http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6820
6821 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6822 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6823 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6824 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6825 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006826 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006827 processing.
6828
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006829 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006830 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006831 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006832 rules evaluation.
6833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006834http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6835http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6836http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006837
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006838 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6839 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6840 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6841 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6842 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6843 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6844
6845http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6846
6847 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6848 about <var-name>.
6849
6850 Example:
6851 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6852
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006853
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006854http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6855 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6856
6857 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6858 yes | no | yes | yes
6859
6860 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006861 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6862 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6863 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006864
6865 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6866
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006867 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6868 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6869 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6870 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6871 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6872 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6873 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6874 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6875 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6876 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006877
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006878 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6879 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6880 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6881 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6882 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6883 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6884 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006885 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6886 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6887 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6888 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6889 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6890 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006891
6892 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6893 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6894 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6895 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6896 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6897 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6898 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6899 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006900 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006901 downsides of rare connection failures.
6902
6903 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6904 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6905 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6906 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6907 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6908 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006909 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006910 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6911 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6912 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6913 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6914 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6915
6916 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006917 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6918 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6919 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006920
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006921 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6922 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6923 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006924
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006925 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6926 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006927
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006928 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006929
6930 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6931 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6932 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6933
6934 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6935
6936
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006937http-send-name-header [<header>]
6938 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6940 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006941 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006942 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6943
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006944 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6945 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6946 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6947 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6948 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6949 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6950 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6951 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6952 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6953 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6954 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6955 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6956 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6957 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6958 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6959 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006960
6961 See also : "server"
6962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006963id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006964 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6966 no | yes | yes | yes
6967 Arguments : none
6968
6969 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6970 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6971 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006972
6973
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006974ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6975 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006977 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006978
6979 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6980 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6981 and running).
6982
6983 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6984 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6985 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006986 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006987 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6988
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006989 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6990 "unless" condition is met.
6991
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006992 Example:
6993 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6994 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6995 ignore-persist if url_static
6996
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006997 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6998
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006999load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7000 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7002 yes | no | yes | yes
7003
7004 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7005 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7006 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007007 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007008 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7009 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7010 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7011 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7012
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007013 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007014 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007015 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007016
7017 Arguments:
7018 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7019 named "server-state-file".
7020
7021 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7022 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7023 name is used as a file name.
7024
7025 none don't load any stat for this backend
7026
7027 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007028 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7029 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7030 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007031 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007032 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007033
7034 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7035 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7036
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007037 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007038
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007039 global
7040 stats socket /tmp/socket
7041 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007042
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007043 defaults
7044 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007045
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007046 backend bk
7047 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7048 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007049
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007050
7051 Then one can run :
7052
7053 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7054
7055 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7056
7057 1
7058 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7059 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7060 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7061
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007062 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007063
7064 global
7065 stats socket /tmp/socket
7066 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7067
7068 defaults
7069 load-server-state-from-file local
7070
7071 backend bk
7072 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7073 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7074
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007075
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007076 Then one can run :
7077
7078 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7079
7080 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7081
7082 1
7083 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7084 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7085 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7086
7087 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7088 "show servers state"
7089
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007090
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007091log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007092log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
7093 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007094no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007095 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7097 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007098
7099 Prefix :
7100 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7101 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7102 prefix does not allow arguments.
7103
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007104 Arguments :
7105 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7106 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7107 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7108 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7109 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7110 parameter.
7111
7112 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7113 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7114
7115 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7116 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7117 standard syslog port).
7118
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007119 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7120 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7121 standard syslog port).
7122
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007123 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7124 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7125 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007126 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007127
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007128 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7129 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7130 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7131 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7132 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7133 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7134 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7135 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7136 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7137 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7138 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7139 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7140 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7141 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7142 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7143 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007144 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7145 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007146
7147 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7148 and "fd@2", see above.
7149
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007150 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7151 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7152 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7153 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7154 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7155 having the logs instantly available.
7156
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007157 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7158 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007159
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007160 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7161 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7162 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7163 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7164 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7165 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7166 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7167 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7168 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7169 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007170 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007171
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007172 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7173 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7174 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7175 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7176 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7177
7178 <sample_size>
7179 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7180 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7181 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7182 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7183 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7184
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007185 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7186 one of the following :
7187
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007188 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7189 field is stripped. This is the default.
7190 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7191 rfc3164.
7192
7193 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007194 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7195
7196 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7197 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7198
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007199 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7200 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7201 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7202 designed to be used with a local log server.
7203
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007204 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7205 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7206 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7207 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7208 systemd logger consumes.
7209
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007210 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7211 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7212 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7213 used with a local log server.
7214
7215 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7216 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7217 designed to be used with a local log server.
7218
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007219 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7220 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7221 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7222 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007224 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7225
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007226 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7227 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7228 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7229
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007230 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7231 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7232 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7233 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007234
7235 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7236 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7237 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007238 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7239 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7240 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7241 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7242 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007243
7244 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7245
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007246 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7247 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7248 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007249
7250 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7251 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7252 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7253 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7254
7255 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7256 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007257
7258 Example :
7259 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007260 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7261 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7262 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007263 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7264 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007265 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007266
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007267
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007268log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007269 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7271 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007272
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007273 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7274 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7275 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7276 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7277 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007278
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007279 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7280 "option httplog" directives.
7281
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007282log-format-sd <string>
7283 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7284 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7285 yes | yes | yes | no
7286
7287 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7288 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7289 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7290 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7291 which covers the log format string in depth.
7292
7293 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7294 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7295
7296 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7297 log format to "rfc5424".
7298
7299 Example :
7300 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7301
7302
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007303log-tag <string>
7304 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7306 yes | yes | yes | yes
7307
7308 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7309 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7310 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7311 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7312 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7313 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7314 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7315 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7316 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007317
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007318max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7319 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7320 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7321 yes | no | yes | yes
7322
7323 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7324 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7325 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7326 servers.
7327
7328 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7329 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7330 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7331 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7332 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007333 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007334 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7335 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7336 picking a different server.
7337
7338 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7339 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7340 even if they have to be queued.
7341
7342 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7343 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7344
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007345max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7346 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7347 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7348 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007349
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007350maxconn <conns>
7351 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7353 yes | yes | yes | no
7354 Arguments :
7355 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7356 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7357 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7358 closes.
7359
7360 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7361 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7362 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7363 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007364 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7365 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7366 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7367 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007368
7369 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7370 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7371 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7372
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007373 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7374 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007375
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007376 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7377
7378
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007379mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007380 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7382 yes | yes | yes | yes
7383 Arguments :
7384 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7385 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7386 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7387 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7388
7389 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7390 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7391 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7392 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7393 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7394
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007395 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7396 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7397 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007398
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007399 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007400 defaults http_instances
7401 mode http
7402
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007403
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007404monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007405 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7407 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007408 Arguments :
7409 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7410 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007411 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007412 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7413 backend and its backup.
7414
7415 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7416 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7417 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7418 servers in a list of backends.
7419
7420 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7421 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7422 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7423 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7424 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7425 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7426 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007427 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7428 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007429
7430 Example:
7431 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007432 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007433 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7434 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7435 monitor-uri /site_alive
7436 monitor fail if site_dead
7437
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007438 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007439
7440
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007441monitor-uri <uri>
7442 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7444 yes | yes | yes | no
7445 Arguments :
7446 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7447 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7448
7449 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7450 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7451 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7452 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7453 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7454 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7455 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7456 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7457
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007458 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007459 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7460 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7461 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7462 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7463 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7464 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007465
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007466 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7467 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7468 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7469 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7470
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007471 Example :
7472 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7473 frontend www
7474 mode http
7475 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7476
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007477 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007479
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007480option abortonclose
7481no option abortonclose
7482 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7484 yes | no | yes | yes
7485 Arguments : none
7486
7487 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7488 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7489 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7490 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007491 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007492 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7493 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7494 encountered while delivering the response.
7495
7496 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7497 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7498 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7499 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7500 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7501 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007502 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007503 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007504 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007505 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7506 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7507 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7508
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007509 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7510 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007511 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7512 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7513 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7514 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7515 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7516 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007517 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007518
7519 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7520 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7521
7522 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7523
7524
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007525option accept-invalid-http-request
7526no option accept-invalid-http-request
7527 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7529 yes | yes | yes | no
7530 Arguments : none
7531
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007532 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007533 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007534 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007535 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7536 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7537 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7538 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7539 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007540 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7541 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7542 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7543 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007544 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007545 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007546 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7547 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7548 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007549
7550 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7551 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7552 been confirmed.
7553
7554 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7555 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007556 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7557 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007558 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7559
7560 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7561 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7562
7563 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7564 stats socket.
7565
7566
7567option accept-invalid-http-response
7568no option accept-invalid-http-response
7569 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7571 yes | no | yes | yes
7572 Arguments : none
7573
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007574 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007575 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007576 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007577 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7578 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7579 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7580 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7581 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007582 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7583 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7584 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007585
7586 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7587 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7588 been confirmed.
7589
7590 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7591 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7592 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7593 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7594
7595 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7596 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7597
7598 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7599 stats socket.
7600
7601
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007602option allbackups
7603no option allbackups
7604 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | no | yes | yes
7607 Arguments : none
7608
7609 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7610 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7611 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7612 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7613 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7614 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7615 order between the backup servers anymore.
7616
7617 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7618 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7619
7620 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7621 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7622
7623
7624option checkcache
7625no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007626 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7628 yes | no | yes | yes
7629 Arguments : none
7630
7631 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7632 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007633 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007634 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7635 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007636 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007637
7638 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007639 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007640 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007641 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7642 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007643 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007644 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007645 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7646 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007647 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007648 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7649 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007650 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007651 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7652 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7653 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7654 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7655 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7656 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7657 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7658 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7659 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7660
7661 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007662 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7663 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7664 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7665 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007666
7667 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7668 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007669 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007670 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007671
7672 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7673 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7674
7675
7676option clitcpka
7677no option clitcpka
7678 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7680 yes | yes | yes | no
7681 Arguments : none
7682
7683 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7684 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007685 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007686 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7687
7688 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7689 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7690 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7691 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7692
7693 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7694 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7695 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7696 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7697 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7698
7699 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7700
7701 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7702 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7703 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7704
7705 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7706 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7707
7708 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7709
7710
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007711option contstats
7712 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7714 yes | yes | yes | no
7715 Arguments : none
7716
7717 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7718 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7719 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7720 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007721 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7722 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7723 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7724 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7725 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007726
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007727option disable-h2-upgrade
7728no option disable-h2-upgrade
7729 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7730 connection.
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 yes | yes | yes | no
7733 Arguments : none
7734
7735 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7736 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7737 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7738 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7739 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7740 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7741 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7742 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7743
7744 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7745 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007746
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007747option dontlog-normal
7748no option dontlog-normal
7749 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7751 yes | yes | yes | no
7752 Arguments : none
7753
7754 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7755 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7756 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7757 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7758 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7759 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7760 logged.
7761
7762 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7763 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7764 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007766 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007767 logging.
7768
7769
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007770option dontlognull
7771no option dontlognull
7772 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7774 yes | yes | yes | no
7775 Arguments : none
7776
7777 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7778 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7779 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7780 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7781 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7782 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007783 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7784 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7785 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007786
7787 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007788 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007789 would not be logged.
7790
7791 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7792 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7793
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007794 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007795 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007796
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007797
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007798option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007799 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7801 yes | yes | yes | yes
7802 Arguments :
7803 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7804 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007805 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007806 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007807
7808 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7809 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7810 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7811 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7812 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7813 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7814 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007815 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7816 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7817 possible that the client has already brought one.
7818
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007819 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007820 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007821 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007822 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007823 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007824 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007825
7826 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7827 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7828 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7829 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7830 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7831 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7832 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7833
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007834 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7835 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7836 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7837 are under the control of the end-user.
7838
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007839 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007840 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7841 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007842 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7843 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7844 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007845
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007846 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007847 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7848 frontend www
7849 mode http
7850 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7851
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007852 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7853 backend www
7854 mode http
7855 option forwardfor header X-Client
7856
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007857 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007858 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007859
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007860
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007861option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7862no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7863 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7865 yes | yes | yes | no
7866 Arguments : none
7867
7868 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7869 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7870 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7871 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7872 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7873 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7874 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7875
7876 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7877 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7878 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7879 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7880 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7881 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7882 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7883 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7884 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7885 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7886
7887 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7888
7889 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7890 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7891
7892 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7893 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7894
7895
7896option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7897no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7898 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7900 yes | no | yes | yes
7901 Arguments : none
7902
7903 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7904 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7905 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7906 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7907 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7908 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7909 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7910
7911 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7912 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7913 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7914 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7915 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7916 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7917 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7918 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7919 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7920 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7921
7922 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7923
7924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7926
7927 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7928 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7929
7930
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007931option http-buffer-request
7932no option http-buffer-request
7933 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 yes | yes | yes | yes
7936 Arguments : none
7937
7938 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7939 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7940 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7941 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7942 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7943 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007944 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7945 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7946 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7947 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007948
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007949 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007950
7951
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007952option http-ignore-probes
7953no option http-ignore-probes
7954 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7956 yes | yes | yes | no
7957 Arguments : none
7958
7959 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7960 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7961 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7962 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7963 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7964 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7965 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7966 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7967 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007968 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7969 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007970 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7971
7972 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7973 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7974 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7975 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7976 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7977 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7978 are often the only way to detect them.
7979
7980 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7981 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7982
7983 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7984
7985
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007986option http-keep-alive
7987no option http-keep-alive
7988 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7990 yes | yes | yes | yes
7991 Arguments : none
7992
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007993 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7994 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007995 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7996 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007997 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7998 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7999 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008000
8001 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8002 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008003 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8004 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8005 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8006 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8007 situations where this option may be useful :
8008
8009 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008010 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008011
8012 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8013 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8014
8015 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8016 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8017 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8018 request.
8019
8020 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8021 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008022 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8023 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8024 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008025
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008026 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8027 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8028 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8029 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8030 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8031 not set.
8032
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008033 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8034 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8035 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008036
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008037 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008038 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008039 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008040
8041
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008042option http-no-delay
8043no option http-no-delay
8044 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8046 yes | yes | yes | yes
8047 Arguments : none
8048
8049 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8050 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8051 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8052 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8053 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8054 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8055 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8056 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8057 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8058 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8059 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8060 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8061 affected.
8062
8063 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8064 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8065 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8066 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8067 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8068 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8069 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8070 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8071 latency environments.
8072
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008073 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8074
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008075
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008076option http-pretend-keepalive
8077no option http-pretend-keepalive
8078 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008080 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008081 Arguments : none
8082
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008083 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008084 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8085 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8086 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8087 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8088 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8089 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8090 consider the response complete.
8091
8092 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8093 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8094 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8095 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008096 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008097 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8098
8099 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8100 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8101 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8102 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8103 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8104 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8105 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8106
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008107 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8108 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8109 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8110 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8111 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8112 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008113
8114 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8115 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8116
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008117 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008118 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008119
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008120
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008121option http-server-close
8122no option http-server-close
8123 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8125 yes | yes | yes | yes
8126 Arguments : none
8127
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008128 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8129 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8130 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8131 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008132 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8133 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8134 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8135 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8136 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8137 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8138 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8139 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8140 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8141 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8142 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008143
8144 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8145 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8146 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8147 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008148 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8149 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008150
8151 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8152 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008153 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8154 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8155 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008156
8157 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8158 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8159
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008160 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8161 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008162
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008163option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008164no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008165 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8167 yes | yes | yes | no
8168 Arguments : none
8169
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008170 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008171 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8172 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8173 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8174 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8175 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8176 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8177
8178 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8179 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008180 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8181 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8182 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008183
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008184 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8185 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8186 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8187 front of an existing proxy.
8188
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008189 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8190
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008191 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008192
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008193option httpchk
8194option httpchk <uri>
8195option httpchk <method> <uri>
8196option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008197 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8199 yes | no | yes | yes
8200 Arguments :
8201 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8202 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8203 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8204 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8205 ones.
8206
8207 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8208 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8209 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8210
8211 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8212 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8213 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008214 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008215
8216 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8217 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8218 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8219 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8220 the lack of any response.
8221
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008222 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8223 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8224 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8225 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8226
8227 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8228 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8229 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008230
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008231 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8232 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008233 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008234 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008235 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008236
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008237 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8238 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8239 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8240 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8241
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008242 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008243 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8244 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8245 backend https_relay
8246 mode tcp
8247 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8248 http-check send hdr Host www
8249 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008250
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008251 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8252 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8253 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008254
8255
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008256option httpclose
8257no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008258 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8260 yes | yes | yes | yes
8261 Arguments : none
8262
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008263 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8264 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8265 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8266 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008267 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008268
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008269 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8270 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008271 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008272 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8273 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008274
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008275 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8276 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8277 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008278
8279 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8280 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008281 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8282 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8283 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008284
8285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8287
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008288 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008289
8290
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008291option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008292 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008294 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008295 Arguments :
8296 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8297 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8298 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008299 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008300 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008301
8302 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8303 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8304 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8305 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8306 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8307 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8308 ports.
8309
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008310 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8311 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008312
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008313 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008315 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008316
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008317
8318option http_proxy
8319no option http_proxy
8320 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8322 yes | yes | yes | yes
8323 Arguments : none
8324
8325 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8326 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8327 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8328 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8329 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8330
8331 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8332 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008333 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8334 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008335
8336 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8337 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8338
8339 Example :
8340 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8341 backend direct_forward
8342 option httpclose
8343 option http_proxy
8344
8345 See also : "option httpclose"
8346
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008347
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008348option independent-streams
8349no option independent-streams
8350 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8352 yes | yes | yes | yes
8353 Arguments : none
8354
8355 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8356 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8357 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8358 receive data or not.
8359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008360 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008361 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8362 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8363 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8364 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8365 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8366 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8367 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8368 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8369 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8370 socket buffers.
8371
8372 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8373 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8374 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8375 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8376 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8377
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008378 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008379
8380
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008381option ldap-check
8382 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8384 yes | no | yes | yes
8385 Arguments : none
8386
8387 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8388 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8389 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8390 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8391
8392 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8393 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8394
8395 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8396 configure it.
8397
8398 Example :
8399 option ldap-check
8400
8401 See also : "option httpchk"
8402
8403
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008404option external-check
8405 Use external processes for server health checks
8406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8407 yes | no | yes | yes
8408
8409 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8410 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8411 command".
8412
8413 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8414
8415 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8416
8417
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008418option log-health-checks
8419no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008420 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8422 yes | no | yes | yes
8423 Arguments : none
8424
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008425 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8426 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8427 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008428
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008429 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8430 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8431 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8432 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8433 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8434
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008435 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008436 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008437
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008438 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8439 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8440 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008441
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008442
8443option log-separate-errors
8444no option log-separate-errors
8445 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8447 yes | yes | yes | no
8448 Arguments : none
8449
8450 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8451 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8452 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8453 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8454 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8455 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8456 provides very important information.
8457
8458 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8459 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8460 error logs.
8461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008462 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008463 logging.
8464
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008465
8466option logasap
8467no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008468 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8470 yes | yes | yes | no
8471 Arguments : none
8472
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008473 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8474 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8475 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8476 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8477
8478 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8479 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8480 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8481 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8482 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008483 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008484 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8485 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8486 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8487 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008488 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008489
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008490 Examples :
8491 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8492 mode http
8493 option httplog
8494 option logasap
8495 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8496
8497 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8498 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8499 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8500 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008502 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008503 logging.
8504
8505
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008506option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008507 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8509 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008510 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008511 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8512 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008513 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8514 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008515
8516 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8517 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008518 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008519 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8520 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8521 in the MySQL table, like this :
8522
8523 USE mysql;
8524 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8525 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8526
8527 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008528 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008529 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8530 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8531 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8532 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8533 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8534 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8535 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8536
8537 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8538 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008539
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008540 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008541
8542 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8543 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8544 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8545 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008546 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8547 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008548
8549 See also: "option httpchk"
8550
8551
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008552option nolinger
8553no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008554 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8556 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008557 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008558
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008559 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008560 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8561 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8562 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8563 connections.
8564
8565 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8566 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008567 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8568 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8569 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8570 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8571 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8572 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8573 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8574 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8575 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8576 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8577 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8578 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8579 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008580
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008581 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8582 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8583 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8584 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8585 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008586
8587 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8588 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008589 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8590 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8591 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008592
8593 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8594 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8595
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008596 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8597 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008598
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008599option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8600 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8602 yes | yes | yes | yes
8603 Arguments :
8604 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8605 matching <network>
8606 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8607 header name.
8608
8609 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8610 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8611 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8612 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8613 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8614 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8615 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8616 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8617 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8618 possible that the client has already brought one.
8619
8620 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8621 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8622 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8623 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8624 header and requires different one.
8625
8626 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8627 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8628 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8629 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8630 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8631 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8632 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8633
8634 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8635 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8636 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8637 both are defined.
8638
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008639 Examples :
8640 # Original Destination address
8641 frontend www
8642 mode http
8643 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8644
8645 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8646 backend www
8647 mode http
8648 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8649
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008650 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008651
8652
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008653option persist
8654no option persist
8655 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8656 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8657 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008658 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008659
8660 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8661 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8662 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8663 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8664 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8665 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8666 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8667 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8668 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8669 redirected to another valid server.
8670
8671 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8672 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8673
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008674 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008675
8676
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008677option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8678 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8680 yes | no | yes | yes
8681 Arguments :
8682 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8683 PostgreSQL server.
8684
8685 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8686 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8687 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8688 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8689
8690 See also: "option httpchk"
8691
8692
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008693option prefer-last-server
8694no option prefer-last-server
8695 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8696 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8697 yes | no | yes | yes
8698 Arguments : none
8699
8700 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8701 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8702 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8703 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8704 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8705 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8706 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8707 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8708 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008709 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8710 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008711 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8712 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8713 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008714 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8715 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8716 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008717
8718 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8719 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8720
8721 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8722
8723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008724option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008725option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008726no option redispatch
8727 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8728 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8729 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008730 Arguments :
8731 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8732 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8733 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008734 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008735 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008736 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008737 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8738 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8739 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008741
8742 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8743 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8744 be able to access the service anymore.
8745
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008746 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8747 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008748
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008749 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8750 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8751 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8752 following order:
8753
8754 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8755
8756 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8757 list, or
8758
8759 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8760
8761 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8762 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8763
8764 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8765 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8766 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8767 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8768
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008769 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008770 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8771 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008773 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8774 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8775
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008776 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008777
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008778
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008779option redis-check
8780 Use redis health checks for server testing
8781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8782 yes | no | yes | yes
8783 Arguments : none
8784
8785 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8786 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8787 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8788 find the "+PONG" response message.
8789
8790 Example :
8791 option redis-check
8792
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008793 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008794
8795
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008796option smtpchk
8797option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8798 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8800 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008801 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008802 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008803 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008804 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8805
8806 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8807 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8808 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8809
8810 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8811 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8812 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8813 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8814 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8815 dead server.
8816
8817 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8818 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008819 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008820 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8821
8822 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8823 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8824 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8825 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008826 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008827
8828 Example :
8829 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8830
8831 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008834option socket-stats
8835no option socket-stats
8836
8837 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8839 yes | yes | yes | no
8840
8841 Arguments : none
8842
8843
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008844option splice-auto
8845no option splice-auto
8846 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8848 yes | yes | yes | yes
8849 Arguments : none
8850
8851 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8852 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008853 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008854 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008855 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008856 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8857 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8858 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8859 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8860
8861 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8862 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8863 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8864 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8865 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8866 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8867 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8868 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8869 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8870 keyword.
8871
8872 Example :
8873 option splice-auto
8874
8875 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8876 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8877
8878 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8879 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8880
8881
8882option splice-request
8883no option splice-request
8884 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8886 yes | yes | yes | yes
8887 Arguments : none
8888
8889 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008890 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008891 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8892 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8893 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8894 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8895
8896 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8897
8898 Example :
8899 option splice-request
8900
8901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8903
8904 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8905 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8906
8907
8908option splice-response
8909no option splice-response
8910 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8912 yes | yes | yes | yes
8913 Arguments : none
8914
8915 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008916 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008917 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8918 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8919 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8920 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8921
8922 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8923
8924 Example :
8925 option splice-response
8926
8927 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8928 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8929
8930 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8931 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8932
8933
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008934option spop-check
8935 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8937 no | no | no | yes
8938 Arguments : none
8939
8940 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8941 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8942 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8943 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8944
8945 Example :
8946 option spop-check
8947
8948 See also : "option httpchk"
8949
8950
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008951option srvtcpka
8952no option srvtcpka
8953 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8955 yes | no | yes | yes
8956 Arguments : none
8957
8958 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8959 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008960 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008961 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8962
8963 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8964 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8965 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8966 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8967
8968 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8969 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8970 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8971 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8972 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8973
8974 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8975
8976 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8977 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8978 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8979
8980 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8981 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8982
8983 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8984
8985
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008986option ssl-hello-chk
8987 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8989 yes | no | yes | yes
8990 Arguments : none
8991
8992 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8993 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8994 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8995 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8996 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8997 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8998 hello message.
8999
9000 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9001 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9002 messages, which is appreciable.
9003
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009004 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9005 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9006 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009007
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009008 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9009
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009010
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009011option tcp-check
9012 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9013 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9014 yes | no | yes | yes
9015
9016 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9017 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9018
9019 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9020 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9021 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9022
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009023 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009024 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9025 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9026 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9027 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9028 only.
9029
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009030 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009031 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9032 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9033 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9034 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9035
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009036 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009037 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9038 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009039 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009040 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9041 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9042 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9043 the respective protocols.
9044 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009045 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009046
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009047 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009048
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009049 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9050 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9051 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9052 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009053
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009054 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9055 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9056 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009057
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009058
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009059 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009060 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009061 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009062 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009063
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009064 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009065 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009066 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009067
9068 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9069 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009070 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009071 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009072 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009073 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009074 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009075 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009076 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9077 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009078 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009079 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9080 tcp-check expect string +OK
9081
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009082 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009083 (send many headers before analyzing)
9084 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009085 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009086 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9087 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9088 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9089 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009090 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009091
9092
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009093 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009094
9095
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009096option tcp-smart-accept
9097no option tcp-smart-accept
9098 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9100 yes | yes | yes | no
9101 Arguments : none
9102
9103 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9104 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9105 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9106 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9107 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9108 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9109
9110 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9111 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9112 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9113 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9114
9115 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9116 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9117 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009118 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009119
9120 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9121 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9122 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9123
9124 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9125 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9126 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9127
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009128 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9129
9130
9131option tcp-smart-connect
9132no option tcp-smart-connect
9133 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9135 yes | no | yes | yes
9136 Arguments : none
9137
9138 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9139 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9140 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9141 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9142 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9143
9144 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9145 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9146 complex.
9147
9148 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9149 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9150 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9151
9152 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9153 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9154
9155 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9156
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009157
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009158option tcpka
9159 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9161 yes | yes | yes | yes
9162 Arguments : none
9163
9164 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9165 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009166 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009167 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9168
9169 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9170 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9171 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9172 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9173
9174 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9175 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9176 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9177 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9178 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9179
9180 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9181
9182 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9183 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9184 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9185 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9186 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9187 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9188 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9189 backends.
9190
9191 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9192
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009193
9194option tcplog
9195 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009197 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009198 Arguments : none
9199
9200 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9201 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9202 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9203 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9204 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9205 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9206 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9207 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9208
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009209 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009211 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009212
9213
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009214option transparent
9215no option transparent
9216 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009218 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009219 Arguments : none
9220
9221 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9222 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9223 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9224 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9225 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9226 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9227 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9228 appropriate server.
9229
9230 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9231 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9232
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009233 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009234 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009235
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009236
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009237external-check command <command>
9238 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9240 yes | no | yes | yes
9241
9242 Arguments :
9243 <command> is the external command to run
9244
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009245 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9246
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009247 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009248
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009249 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9250 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9251 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9252 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9253 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9254 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009255
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009256 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9257
9258 Environment variables :
9259 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9260 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9261
9262 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9263
9264 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9265
9266 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9267 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9268 for a UNIX socket).
9269
9270 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9271
9272 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9273
9274 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9275
9276 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9277
9278 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9279
9280 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9281 socket).
9282
9283 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9284 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9285
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009286 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9287
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009288 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9289 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9290 failed.
9291
9292 Example :
9293 external-check command /bin/true
9294
9295 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9296
9297
9298external-check path <path>
9299 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9301 yes | no | yes | yes
9302
9303 Arguments :
9304 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9305
9306 The default path is "".
9307
9308 Example :
9309 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9310
9311 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9312 "external-check command"
9313
9314
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009315persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009316persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009317 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9319 yes | no | yes | yes
9320 Arguments :
9321 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009322 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9323 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009324
9325 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9326 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009327 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009328 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9329 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9330 forwarded to this server.
9331
9332 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9333 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9334 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009335 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009336 a single "listen" section.
9337
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009338 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9339 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9340 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9341
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009342 Example :
9343 listen tse-farm
9344 bind :3389
9345 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9346 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9347 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9348 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9349 persist rdp-cookie
9350 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009351 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009352 balance rdp-cookie
9353 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9354 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9355
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009356 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9357 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009358
9359
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009360rate-limit sessions <rate>
9361 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9363 yes | yes | yes | no
9364 Arguments :
9365 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9366 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9367
9368 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9369 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9370 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9371 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9372 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9373 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9374
9375 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9376 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9377 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9378 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9379
9380 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9381 listen smtp
9382 mode tcp
9383 bind :25
9384 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009385 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009386
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009387 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9388 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9389 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009390
9391 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9392
9393
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009394redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9395redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9396redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009397 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9399 no | yes | yes | yes
9400
9401 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009402 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009403
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009404 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009405 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009406 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9407 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9408 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009409
9410 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9411 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9412 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9413 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9414 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009415 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9416 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9417 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9418 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009419
9420 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9421 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9422 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9423 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9424 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9425 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009426 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009427 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009428 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9429 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9430 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009431
9432 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009433 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9434 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9435 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009436 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009437 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9438 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9439 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9440 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009441
9442 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009443 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009444
9445 - "drop-query"
9446 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9447 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9448 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9449 with a location-type redirect.
9450
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009451 - "append-slash"
9452 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9453 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9454 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9455 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9456
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009457 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9458 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9459 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9460 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9461 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9462 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9463 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9464
9465 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9466 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9467 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9468 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9469 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9470 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9471 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009472
9473 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9474 acl clear dst_port 80
9475 acl secure dst_port 8080
9476 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009477 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009478 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009479 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9480
9481 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009482 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9483 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9484 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009485 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009486
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009487 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9488 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9489 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9490
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009491 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009492 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009493
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009494 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009495 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9496 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9497 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009499 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009500
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009501
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009502retries <value>
9503 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9504 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9505 yes | no | yes | yes
9506 Arguments :
9507 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9508 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9509 default value is 3.
9510
9511 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9512 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9513 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9514
9515 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009516 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9517 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009518
9519 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9520 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9521
9522 See also : "option redispatch"
9523
9524
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009525retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009526 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9527 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9528 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009529 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9530 yes | no | yes | yes
9531 Arguments :
9532 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9533 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9534 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9535 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9536
9537 none never retry
9538
9539 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9540 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9541
9542 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9543 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9544 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9545 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9546 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9547 processing the request.
9548
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009549 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9550 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9551 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9552 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9553 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9554 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9555 overflow attack for example).
9556
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009557 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9558 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9559 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9560 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9561 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9562 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9563 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9564 amplify denial of service attacks.
9565
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009566 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9567 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9568 considered to be safe to retry.
9569
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009570 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9571 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9572 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9573 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9574 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009575
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009576 all-retryable-errors
9577 retry request for any error that are considered
9578 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9579 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9580 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9581
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009582 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9583 not cumulative.
9584
9585 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9586 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9587 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9588 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9589
9590 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9591 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9592 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9593 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9594 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9595 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9596 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9597 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9598 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9599 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9600 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9601 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9602
9603 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9604 should not use this directive.
9605
9606 The default is "conn-failure".
9607
9608 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9609
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009610server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009611 Declare a server in a backend
9612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9613 no | no | yes | yes
9614 Arguments :
9615 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009616 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009617 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009618
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009619 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9620 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9621 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9622 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009623 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9624 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9625 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9626 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9627 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009628 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9629 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9630 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9631 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9632 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9633 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9634 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009635 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009636 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9637 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9638 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9639 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9640 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9641 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009642 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9643 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009644 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9645 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009646
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009647 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009648 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9649 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9650 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9651 adding this value to the client's port.
9652
9653 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9654 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009655 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009656
9657 Examples :
9658 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9659 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009660 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009661 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9662 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9663 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009664
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009665 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9666 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9667 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9668 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9669 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9670
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009671 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9672 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009673
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009674server-state-file-name [<file>]
9675 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9676 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9677 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9678 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9679 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9680 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9681
9682 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9683 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9684
9685 global
9686 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9687
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009688 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009689 load-server-state-from-file
9690
9691 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9692 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009693
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009694server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9695 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9696 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9698 no | no | yes | yes
9699
9700 Arguments:
9701 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9702
9703 <num | range>
9704 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9705 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9706 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9707 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9708
9709 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9710
9711 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9712
9713 <params*>
9714 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9715 keyword.
9716
9717 Examples:
9718 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9719 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9720 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9721
9722 # or
9723 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9724
9725 # would be equivalent to:
9726 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9727 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9728 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9729
9730
9731
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009732source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009733source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009734source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009735 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9737 yes | no | yes | yes
9738 Arguments :
9739 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9740 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009741
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009742 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009743 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9744 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9745 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9746 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9747 supported prefixes are :
9748 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9749 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9750 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009751 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009752 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9753 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009754
9755 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9756 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009757 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9758 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9759 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009760
9761 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9762 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9763 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9764 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9765 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9766 <addr>.
9767
9768 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9769 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9770 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9771 port.
9772
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009773 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9774 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9775 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9776 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009777 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009778 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9779 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9780 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9781 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9782 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9783 HTTP header.
9784
9785 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9786 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009787 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009788 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9789 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9790 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9791 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9792 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9793 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9794 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9795
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009796 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9797 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9798 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9799 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9800 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9801 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9802
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009803 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9804 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9805 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9806 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9807
9808 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9809 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9810 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9811 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9812 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9813 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9814
9815 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9816 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9817 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9818 there are two methods :
9819
9820 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9821 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9822 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9823 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9824 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9825 of the client ranges may be used.
9826
9827 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9828 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9829 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9830 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9831 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9832 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9833 same session.
9834
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009835 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9836 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9837 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009838 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009839
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009840 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9841
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009842 Examples :
9843 backend private
9844 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9845 source 192.168.1.200
9846
9847 backend transparent_ssl1
9848 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9849 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9850
9851 backend transparent_ssl2
9852 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9853 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9854 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9855
9856 backend transparent_ssl3
9857 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9858 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9859 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9860
9861 backend transparent_smtp
9862 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9863 # with Tproxy version 4.
9864 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9865
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009866 backend transparent_http
9867 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9868 # proxy.
9869 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009871 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009872 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9873
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009874
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009875srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9876 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9877 the connection on the server side.
9878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9879 yes | no | yes | yes
9880 Arguments :
9881 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9882
9883 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9884 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009885 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9886 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009887
9888 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9889
9890
9891srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9892 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9893 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9894 server side.
9895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9896 yes | no | yes | yes
9897 Arguments :
9898 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9899 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9900 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9901 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9902
9903 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9904 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009905 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9906 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009907
9908 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9909
9910
9911srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9912 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9914 yes | no | yes | yes
9915 Arguments :
9916 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9917 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9918 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9919 document.
9920
9921 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9922 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009923 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9924 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009925
9926 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9927
9928
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009929stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9930 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009932 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009933
9934 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9935 matched.
9936
9937 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9938 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9939
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009940 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9941 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009942 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009943
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009944 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9945 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9946 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9947 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009948
9949 Example :
9950 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9951 backend stats_localhost
9952 stats enable
9953 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9954
9955 Example :
9956 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9957 backend stats_auth
9958 stats enable
9959 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9960 stats admin if TRUE
9961
9962 Example :
9963 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9964 userlist stats-auth
9965 group admin users admin
9966 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9967 group readonly users haproxy
9968 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9969
9970 backend stats_auth
9971 stats enable
9972 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9973 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9974 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9975 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9976
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009977 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9978 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9979 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009980
9981
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009982stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9983 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009985 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009986 Arguments :
9987 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9988
9989 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9990
9991 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9992 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9993 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9994 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9995 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9996 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9997
9998 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9999 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10000 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010001 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010002
10003 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10004 report using "stats scope".
10005
10006 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10007 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10008 unobvious parameters.
10009
10010 Example :
10011 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10012 backend public_www
10013 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10014 stats enable
10015 stats hide-version
10016 stats scope .
10017 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010018 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010019 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10020 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10021
10022 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10023 backend private_monitoring
10024 stats enable
10025 stats uri /admin?stats
10026 stats refresh 5s
10027
10028 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10029
10030
10031stats enable
10032 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010034 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010035 Arguments : none
10036
10037 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10038 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10039 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10040 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10041 - stats auth : no authentication
10042 - stats scope : no restriction
10043
10044 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10045 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10046 unobvious parameters.
10047
10048 Example :
10049 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10050 backend public_www
10051 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10052 stats enable
10053 stats hide-version
10054 stats scope .
10055 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010056 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010057 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10058 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10059
10060 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10061 backend private_monitoring
10062 stats enable
10063 stats uri /admin?stats
10064 stats refresh 5s
10065
10066 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10067
10068
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010069stats hide-version
10070 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010072 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010073 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010074
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010075 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10076 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10077 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10078 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10079 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10080 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010082 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10083 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10084 unobvious parameters.
10085
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010086 Example :
10087 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10088 backend public_www
10089 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010090 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010091 stats hide-version
10092 stats scope .
10093 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010094 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010095 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10096 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010097
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010098 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10099 backend private_monitoring
10100 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010101 stats uri /admin?stats
10102 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010103
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010104 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010105
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010106
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010107stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10108 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10109 Access control for statistics
10110
10111 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10112 no | no | yes | yes
10113
10114 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10115 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10116 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10117 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10118 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10119 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10120
10121 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10122 instance.
10123
10124 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10125 about ACL usage.
10126
10127
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010128stats realm <realm>
10129 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010131 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010132 Arguments :
10133 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10134 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10135 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10136
10137 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10138 using a backslash ('\').
10139
10140 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10141 only related to authentication.
10142
10143 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10144 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10145 unobvious parameters.
10146
10147 Example :
10148 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10149 backend public_www
10150 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10151 stats enable
10152 stats hide-version
10153 stats scope .
10154 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010155 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010156 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10157 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10158
10159 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10160 backend private_monitoring
10161 stats enable
10162 stats uri /admin?stats
10163 stats refresh 5s
10164
10165 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10166
10167
10168stats refresh <delay>
10169 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010171 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010172 Arguments :
10173 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10174 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10175 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10176 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10177 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10178 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10179
10180 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10181 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10182 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010183 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010184
10185 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10186 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10187 unobvious parameters.
10188
10189 Example :
10190 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10191 backend public_www
10192 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10193 stats enable
10194 stats hide-version
10195 stats scope .
10196 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010197 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010198 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10199 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10200
10201 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10202 backend private_monitoring
10203 stats enable
10204 stats uri /admin?stats
10205 stats refresh 5s
10206
10207 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10208
10209
10210stats scope { <name> | "." }
10211 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010213 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010214 Arguments :
10215 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10216 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10217 section in which the statement appears.
10218
10219 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10220 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10221 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10222 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10223 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10224 exists.
10225
10226 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10227 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10228 unobvious parameters.
10229
10230 Example :
10231 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10232 backend public_www
10233 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10234 stats enable
10235 stats hide-version
10236 stats scope .
10237 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010238 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010239 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10240 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10241
10242 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10243 backend private_monitoring
10244 stats enable
10245 stats uri /admin?stats
10246 stats refresh 5s
10247
10248 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10249
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010250
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010251stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010252 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010254 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010255
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010256 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010257 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10258
10259 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10260 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10261
10262 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10263 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010264 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010265
10266 Example :
10267 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10268 backend private_monitoring
10269 stats enable
10270 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10271 stats uri /admin?stats
10272 stats refresh 5s
10273
10274 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10275 global section.
10276
10277
10278stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010279 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10281 yes | yes | yes | yes
10282 Arguments : none
10283
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010284 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010285 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10286 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10287 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10288 - IP (socket, server)
10289 - cookie (backend, server)
10290
10291 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10292 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010293 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010294
10295 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10296
10297
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010298stats show-modules
10299 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10301 yes | yes | yes | yes
10302 Arguments : none
10303
10304 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10305 values as a tooltip.
10306
10307 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10308 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10309 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10310
10311 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10312
10313
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010314stats show-node [ <name> ]
10315 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010317 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010318 Arguments:
10319 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10320 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10321
10322 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10323 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010324 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010325
10326 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10327 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10328 unobvious parameters.
10329
10330 Example:
10331 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10332 backend private_monitoring
10333 stats enable
10334 stats show-node Europe-1
10335 stats uri /admin?stats
10336 stats refresh 5s
10337
10338 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10339 section.
10340
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010341
10342stats uri <prefix>
10343 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010345 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010346 Arguments :
10347 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10348 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10349 query string.
10350
10351 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10352 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10353 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10354 possible to reach it in the application.
10355
10356 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010357 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010358 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10359 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10360 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10361 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10362
10363 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10364 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10365 an address or a port to statistics only.
10366
10367 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10368 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10369 unobvious parameters.
10370
10371 Example :
10372 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10373 backend public_www
10374 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10375 stats enable
10376 stats hide-version
10377 stats scope .
10378 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010379 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010380 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10381 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10382
10383 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10384 backend private_monitoring
10385 stats enable
10386 stats uri /admin?stats
10387 stats refresh 5s
10388
10389 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10390
10391
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010392stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10393 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010395 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010396
10397 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010398 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010399 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010400 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010401 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10402
10403 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10404 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10405 the "stick-table" statement.
10406
10407 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10408 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10409 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10410 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10411 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10412
10413 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10414 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10415 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10416 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10417 transformation rules.
10418
10419 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10420 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10421 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10422 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10423 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10424 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10425 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10426
10427 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10428 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10429 ACL based conditions.
10430
10431 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10432 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10433 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10434 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10435
10436 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10437 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10438 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10439 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10440
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010441 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10442 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010443 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010444
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010445 Example :
10446 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10447 # last 30 minutes
10448 backend pop
10449 mode tcp
10450 balance roundrobin
10451 stick store-request src
10452 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10453 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10454 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10455
10456 backend smtp
10457 mode tcp
10458 balance roundrobin
10459 stick match src table pop
10460 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10461 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10462
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010463 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010464 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010465
10466
10467stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10468 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10470 no | no | yes | yes
10471
10472 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10473 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10474 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10475 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10476
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010477 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10478 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010479 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010480
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010481 Examples :
10482 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010483 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010484
10485 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10486 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10487 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10488
10489
10490 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10491 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10492 backend http
10493 mode http
10494 balance roundrobin
10495 stick on src table https
10496 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10497 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10498 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10499
10500 backend https
10501 mode tcp
10502 balance roundrobin
10503 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10504 stick on src
10505 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10506 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10507
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010508 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010509
10510
10511stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10512 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10514 no | no | yes | yes
10515
10516 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010517 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010518 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010519 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010520 server is selected.
10521
10522 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10523 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10524 the "stick-table" statement.
10525
10526 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10527 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10528 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10529 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10530 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10531 address.
10532
10533 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10534 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10535 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10536 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10537 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10538 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10539 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10540 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10541 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10542 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10543
10544 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10545 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10546 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10547 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10548 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10549 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10550 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10551
10552 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10553 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10554 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10555 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10556
10557 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10558 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10559 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10560 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10561 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10562 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010563 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10564 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10565 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10566 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10567 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10568 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010569
10570 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10571 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10572 the request.
10573
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010574 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10575 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010576 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010577
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010578 Example :
10579 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10580 # last 30 minutes
10581 backend pop
10582 mode tcp
10583 balance roundrobin
10584 stick store-request src
10585 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10586 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10587 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10588
10589 backend smtp
10590 mode tcp
10591 balance roundrobin
10592 stick match src table pop
10593 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10594 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10595
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010596 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010597 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010598
10599
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010600stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010601 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10602 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010603 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010605 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010606
10607 Arguments :
10608 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10609 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10610 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10611 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10612
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010613 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10614 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10615 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10616 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10617
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010618 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10619 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10620 instance.
10621
10622 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10623 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10624 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10625 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10626 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10627 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010628 to 32 characters.
10629
10630 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10631 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10632 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010633 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010634 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10635 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010636
10637 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010638 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10639 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010640 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10641 increase.
10642
10643 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010644 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10645 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10646 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010647
10648 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10649 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10650 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10651 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010652 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010653 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10654 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10655 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10656 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10657 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10658 parameter (see below).
10659
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010660 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10661 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10662 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10663 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10664 soft restart.
10665
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010666 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10667 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010668
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010669 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10670 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10671 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10672 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010673 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010674 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010675 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10676 if not expiration delay is specified.
10677
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010678 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10679 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10680 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10681 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010682 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10683 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10684 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10685 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10686 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10687 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10688 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10689 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10690 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10691 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10692 types and their arguments.
10693
10694 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10695 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10696 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10697 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10698
10699 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10700 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10701 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010702 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010703
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010704 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10705 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10706 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010707 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010708 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010709 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010710
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010711 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10712 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10713 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10714 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10715
10716 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10717 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10718 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10719 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10720 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10721 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10722
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010723 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10724 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10725 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10726 they were received.
10727
10728 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10729 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10730 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10731 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10732 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10733
10734 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10735 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10736 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10737 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10738 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10739
10740 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10741 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10742 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10743
10744 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10745 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10746 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10747 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10748 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10749
10750 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10751 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10752 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10753 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10754 the client side.
10755
10756 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10757 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10758 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10759 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10760 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10761 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10762 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10763
10764 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10765 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10766 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10767 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10768 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10769 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010770 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010771
10772 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10773 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10774 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10775 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10776 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10777 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10778
10779 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010780 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010781 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10782 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10783
10784 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10785 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10786 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10787 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10788 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10789 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10790 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10791 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10792 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10793 recommended for better fairness.
10794
10795 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010796 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010797 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10798 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10799
10800 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10801 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10802 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10803 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10804 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10805 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10806 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10807 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10808 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10809 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010810
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010811 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10812 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010813 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10814 reference it.
10815
10816 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10817 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010818 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10819 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10820 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010821
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010822 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10823 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10824 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10825 something that can be ignored.
10826
10827 Example:
10828 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10829 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10830 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10831 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10832
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010833 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010834 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010835
10836
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010837stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010838 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10840 no | no | yes | yes
10841
10842 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010843 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010844 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010845 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010846 server is selected.
10847
10848 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10849 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10850 the "stick-table" statement.
10851
10852 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10853 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10854 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10855 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10856
10857 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10858 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10859 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10860 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10861 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10862 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010863 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010864 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10865 rules.
10866
10867 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10868 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10869 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10870 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10871 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10872 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10873 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10874
10875 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10876 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10877 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10878 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10879
10880 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10881 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10882 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10883 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10884 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10885 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010886 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10887 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10888 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10889 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10890 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10891 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10892 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10893 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10894 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010895
10896 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10897
10898 Example :
10899 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10900 backend https
10901 mode tcp
10902 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010903 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010904 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010905
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010906 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10907 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10908
10909 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10910 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10911 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10912
10913 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10914 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010915
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010916 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10917 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10918 # at offset 44.
10919
10920 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10921 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10922
10923 # Learn on response if server hello.
10924 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010925
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010926 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10927 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10928
10929 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10930 extraction.
10931
10932
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010933tcp-check comment <string>
10934 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10935 it fails.
10936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10937 yes | no | yes | yes
10938
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010939 Arguments :
10940 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10941 rule fails.
10942
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010943 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10944 user-friendly error reporting.
10945
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010946 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10947 "tcp-check expect".
10948
10949
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010950tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10951 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010952 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010953 Opens a new connection
10954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010956
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010957 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010958 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10959
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010960 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010961 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010962
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010963 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010964 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10965 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010966 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010967
10968 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010969
10970 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10971
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010972 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10973
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010974 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10975
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010976 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10977
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010978 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10979 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10980 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10981 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10982
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010983 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10984 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10985 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10986 haproxy -vv.
10987
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010988 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010989
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010990 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10991 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10992 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10993
10994 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10995 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10996 of the sequence.
10997
10998 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10999 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11000 do.
11001
11002 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11003 unset-var or comment rules.
11004
11005 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011006 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11007 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11008 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11009 option tcp-check
11010 tcp-check connect
11011 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11012 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11013 tcp-check send \r\n
11014 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11015 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11016 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11017 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11018 tcp-check send \r\n
11019 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11020 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11021
11022 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11023 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011024 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011025 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11026 tcp-check connect port 143
11027 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11028 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11029
11030 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11031
11032
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011033tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011034 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011035 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011036 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011037 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011039 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011040
11041 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011042 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11043
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011044 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11045 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11046 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11047 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11048 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11049 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11050 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11051 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11052 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11053 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11054
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011055 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011056 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11057 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011058 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11059 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11060 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11061
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011062 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11063 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11064 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011065 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11066 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011067 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11068 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011069 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11070 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011071 By default "L7OK" is used.
11072
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011073 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11074 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011075 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11076 supported :
11077 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11078 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011079 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11080 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11081 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11082 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11083 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011084
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011085 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011086 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011087 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11088 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11089 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11090 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011091 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11092
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011093 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11094 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11095 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11096 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11097
11098 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11099 informational message reported in logs if an error
11100 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11101 log-format string.
11102
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011103 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11104 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11105 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11106 followed by some converters.
11107
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011108 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11109 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11110 with the usual backslash ('\').
11111 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011112 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011113 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11114 used upper or lower case.
11115
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011116 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11117
11118 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11119 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11120 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11121 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11122 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11123 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11124 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11125 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11126
11127 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11128 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11129 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11130 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11131 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11132 expression.
11133
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011134 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11135 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11136 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11137 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11138 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11139 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11140
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011141 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11142 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11143 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11144 this exact hexadecimal string.
11145 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11146
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011147 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11148 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11149 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11150 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11151 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11152 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11153 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11154 size.
11155
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011156 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11157 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11158 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11159 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11160 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11161 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11162 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11163 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11164 in a binary string before matching the response's
11165 buffer.
11166
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011167 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011168 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011169 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11170 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11171 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11172 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11173 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11174 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11175 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11176 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11177 the null character.
11178
11179 Examples :
11180 # perform a POP check
11181 option tcp-check
11182 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11183
11184 # perform an IMAP check
11185 option tcp-check
11186 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11187
11188 # look for the redis master server
11189 option tcp-check
11190 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011191 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011192 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11193 tcp-check expect string role:master
11194 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11195 tcp-check expect string +OK
11196
11197
11198 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011199 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011200
11201
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011202tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11203tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11204 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11205 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011207 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011208
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011209 Arguments :
11210 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11211
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011212 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11213 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011214
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011215 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11216 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011217
11218 Examples :
11219 # look for the redis master server
11220 option tcp-check
11221 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11222 tcp-check expect string role:master
11223
11224 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011225 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011226
11227
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011228tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11229tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11230 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11231 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011232 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011233 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011234
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011235 Arguments :
11236 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011237
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011238 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11239 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011240
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011241 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11242 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11243 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011244
11245 Examples :
11246 # redis check in binary
11247 option tcp-check
11248 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11249 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11250
11251
11252 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011253 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011254
11255
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011256tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011257 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011259 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011260
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011261 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011262 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11263 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11264 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11265 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11266 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11267 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11268 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11269 and '-'.
11270
11271 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11272
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011273 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011274 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11275
11276
11277tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011278 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011279 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011280 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011281
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011282 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011283 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11284 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11285 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11286 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11287 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11288 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11289 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11290 and '-'.
11291
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011292 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011293 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11294
11295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011296tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11297 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11299 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011300 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011301 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11302 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011304 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011305
11306 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11307 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011308 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11309 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11310 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11311 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11312 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11313 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011314
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011315 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11316 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11317 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11318 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011319
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011320 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011321 - accept :
11322 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11323 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11324 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011325
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011326 - reject :
11327 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11328 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11329 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11330 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11331 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11332 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11333 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11334 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11335 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11336 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11337 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011338 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011339
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011340 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11341 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11342 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11343 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11344 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11345 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11346 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11347 hosts.
11348
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011349 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11350 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11351 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11352 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11353 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11354 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11355 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11356 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11357
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011358 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11359 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11360 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11361 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11362 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11363 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11364 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11365 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11366 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011367 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11368 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011369
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011370 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011371 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011372 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11373 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11374 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011375 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011376 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011377 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11378 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11379 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11380 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11381 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11382 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11383 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011385 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011386 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011387 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011388 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011389 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11390 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11391 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011392
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011393 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11394 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11395 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11396 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011397
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011398 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11399 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11400 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11401 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11402 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011403 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11404 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11405 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11406 layer7 information is extracted.
11407
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011408 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11409 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11410 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11411 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11412 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011413
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011414 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11415 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11416 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11417 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11418
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011419 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11420 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11421 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11422 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11423
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011424 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11425 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11426 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11427 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11428 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011429
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011430 - set-src <expr> :
11431 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11432 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11433 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011434 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011436 Arguments:
11437 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11438 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011439
11440 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011441 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11442
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011443 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11444 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011445
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011446 - set-src-port <expr> :
11447 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11448 expression.
11449
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011450 Arguments:
11451 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11452 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011453
11454 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011455 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11456
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011457 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11458 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11459 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011460
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011461 - set-dst <expr> :
11462 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11463 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11464 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11465 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11466 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11467
11468 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11469 followed by some converters.
11470
11471 Example:
11472
11473 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11474 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11475
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011476 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11477 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11478
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011479 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11480 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11481 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11482 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11483
11484
11485 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11486 followed by some converters.
11487
11488 Example:
11489
11490 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11491
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011492 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11493 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11494 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11495
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011496 - "silent-drop" :
11497 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011498 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011499 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11500 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11501 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11502 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11503 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011504 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11505 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011506 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11507 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011508 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011509 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11510 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11511 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11512 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11513
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011514 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11515 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11516 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011517
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011518 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11519 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11520 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011521
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011522 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011523 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011524 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011525
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011526 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11527 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11528 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011529
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011530 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011531 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11532 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011533
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011534 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11535
11536 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11537
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011538 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11539
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011540 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011541
11542
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011543tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11544 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011546 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011547 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011548 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11549 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011550
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011551 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011552
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011553 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011554 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11555 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11556 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11557 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011558
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011559 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11560 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11561 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11562 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011563 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11564 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11565 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11566 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11567 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11568 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011569 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011570 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011571
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011572 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11573 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11574 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11575 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011576
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011577 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011578 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011579 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011580 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11581 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011582 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011583 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011584 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011585 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011586 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011587 - set-dst <expr>
11588 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011589 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011590 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011591 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011592 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011593 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011594
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011595 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11596 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011597 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11598 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011599
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011600 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11601 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11602 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11603 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11604 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11605 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011606
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011607 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011608 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11609 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011610
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011611 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11612 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11613 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11614 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11615 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11616 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11617
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011618 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011619 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11620 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11621 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11622 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11623 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11624 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11625 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11626 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11627 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11628 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011629
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011630 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011631 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11632 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11633 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011634
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011635 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11636 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11637
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011638 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011639 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11640 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011641
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011642 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11643 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011644 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011645 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11646 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011647 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011648 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011649 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011650 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11651 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011652 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011653 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11654 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011655
11656 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11657 followed by some converters.
11658
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011659 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11660 <var-name>.
11661
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011662 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11663 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11664 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11665 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11666 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11667
11668 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11669 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11670 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11671 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11672 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11673 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11674 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11675 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11676 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11677 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11678 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11679
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011680 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11681 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11682 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11683 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11684 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11685
11686 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11687
11688 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11689
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011690 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11691 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11692 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11693 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11694 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11695 evaluated.
11696
11697 Example:
11698 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11699
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011700 Example:
11701
11702 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011703 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011704
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011705 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011706 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11707 # and reject everything else.
11708 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11709 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011710 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011711 tcp-request content reject
11712
11713 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011714 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11715 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11716 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011717 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011718
11719 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11720 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11721 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011722 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011723 tcp-request content reject
11724
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011725 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011726 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011727 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011728 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011729 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11730 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011731
11732 Example:
11733 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11734 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011735 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011736
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011737 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011738 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011739
11740 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011741 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011742 # protecting all our sites
11743 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011744 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11745 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011746 ...
11747 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11748
11749 backend http_dynamic
11750 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011751 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011752 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011753 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011754 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011755 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011756 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011758 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011759
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011760 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11761 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011762
11763
11764tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11765 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011767 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011768 Arguments :
11769 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11770 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11771 as explained at the top of this document.
11772
11773 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11774 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11775 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11776 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11777 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11778
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011779 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11780 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11781 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11782 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11783
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011784 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11785 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011786 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011787 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011788 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11789 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11790 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11791 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011792
11793 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11794 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11795 it pass through unaffected.
11796
11797 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11798 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11799 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011800 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011801 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11802 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011803 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11804 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11805 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011806
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011807 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011808 "timeout client".
11809
11810
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011811tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11812 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11814 no | no | yes | yes
11815 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011816 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11817 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011818
11819 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11820
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011821 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011822 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11823 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011824 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11825 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011826
11827 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11828
11829 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11830 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11831 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11832 inserted.
11833
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011834 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011835 - accept :
11836 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11837 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11838 the rules evaluation.
11839
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011840 - close :
11841 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11842 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11843 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11844 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11845 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11846 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011847 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011848 protocols.
11849
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011850 - reject :
11851 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11852 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011853 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011854
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011855 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11856 Sets a variable.
11857
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011858 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11859 Unsets a variable.
11860
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011861 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11862 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11863 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11864 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11865
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011866 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11867 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11868 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11869 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11870
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011871 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11872 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11873 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11874 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11875 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011876
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011877 - "silent-drop" :
11878 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011879 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011880 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11881 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11882 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11883 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11884 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011885 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11886 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011887 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11888 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011889 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011890 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11891 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11892 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11893 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11894
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011895 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11896 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11897
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011898 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11899 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11900 for changing the default action to a reject.
11901
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011902 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11903 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11904 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11905 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011906 period.
11907
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011908 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11909 declared inline.
11910
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011911 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11912 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011913 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011914 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11915 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011916 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011917 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011918 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011919 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11920 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011921 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011922 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11923 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011924
11925 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11926 followed by some converters.
11927
11928 Example:
11929
11930 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11931
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011932 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11933 <var-name>.
11934
11935 Example:
11936
11937 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11938
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011939 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11940 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11941 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11942 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11943 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11944
11945 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11946
11947 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11948
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011949 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11950
11951 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11952
11953
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011954tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11955 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11957 no | yes | yes | no
11958 Arguments :
11959 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11960 below.
11961
11962 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11963
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011964 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011965 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11966 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11967 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11968 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11969 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11970 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11971 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011972 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011973 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11974 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11975 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11976 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11977 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11978 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11979 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11980 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11981 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11982 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11983 instead.
11984
11985 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11986 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11987 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11988 rules which may be inserted.
11989
11990 Several types of actions are supported :
11991 - accept : the request is accepted
11992 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11993 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11994 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011995 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011996 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011997 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011998 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011999 - silent-drop
12000
12001 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12002 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12003 sections for a complete description.
12004
12005 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12006 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12007 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12008
12009 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12010 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12011 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12012 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12013 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12014
12015 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12016 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12017
12018 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12019 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12020 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12021
12022 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12023 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12024 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12025
12026 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12027 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12028 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12029
12030 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12031 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12032 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12033
12034 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12035
12036 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12037
12038
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012039tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12040 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12042 no | no | yes | yes
12043 Arguments :
12044 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12045 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12046 as explained at the top of this document.
12047
12048 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12049
12050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012051timeout check <timeout>
12052 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12053 established.
12054
12055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12056 yes | no | yes | yes
12057 Arguments:
12058 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12059 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12060 as explained at the top of this document.
12061
12062 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12063 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012064 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012065 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012066 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12067 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12068 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012069
12070 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12071 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12072
12073 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12074 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012075 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012076
12077 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12078 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12079 forget about it.
12080
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012081 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12082 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012083
12084
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012085timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012086 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12088 yes | yes | yes | no
12089 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012090 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012091 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12092 as explained at the top of this document.
12093
12094 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12095 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12096 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012097 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12098 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12099 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12100 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012101 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12102 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12103 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012104 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012105 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012106 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12107 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012108 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12109 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012110
12111 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12112 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12113 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12114 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012115 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012116 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12117
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012118 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012119
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012120 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012122
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012123timeout client-fin <timeout>
12124 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12126 yes | yes | yes | no
12127 Arguments :
12128 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12129 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12130 as explained at the top of this document.
12131
12132 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12133 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12134 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12135 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12136 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12137 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12138 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012139 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12140 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12141 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012142
12143 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12144 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12145 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12146
12147 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12148
12149
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012150timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012151 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12153 yes | no | yes | yes
12154 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012155 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012156 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12157 as explained at the top of this document.
12158
12159 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012160 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012161 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012162 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012163 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12164 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012165
12166 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12167 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12168 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12169 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012170 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012171 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12172
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012173 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012174
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012175
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012176timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12177 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12179 yes | yes | yes | yes
12180 Arguments :
12181 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12182 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12183 as explained at the top of this document.
12184
12185 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12186 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12187 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12188 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12189 once the request has started to present itself.
12190
12191 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12192 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12193 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12194 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12195 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12196
12197 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12198 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12199 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12200 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12201
12202 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12203 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012204 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012205 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12206 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012207 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012208
12209 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12210 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12211 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12212 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12213
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012214 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12215 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012216 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12217
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012218 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12219
12220
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012221timeout http-request <timeout>
12222 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012224 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012225 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012226 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012227 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12228 as explained at the top of this document.
12229
12230 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12231 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12232 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12233 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12234 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12235 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12236 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012237 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12238 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12239 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12240 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012241 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012242 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12243 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012244
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012245 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12246 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12247 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12248 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12249 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012250 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012251
12252 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12253 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012254 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012255 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12256 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12257
12258 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012259 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12260 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12261 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012262
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012263 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012264 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012265
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012266
12267timeout queue <timeout>
12268 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12270 yes | no | yes | yes
12271 Arguments :
12272 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12273 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12274 as explained at the top of this document.
12275
12276 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12277 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12278 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12279 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12280 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12281
12282 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12283 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12284 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12285 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12286
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012287 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012288
12289
12290timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012291 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12293 yes | no | yes | yes
12294 Arguments :
12295 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12296 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12297 as explained at the top of this document.
12298
12299 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12300 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12301 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12302 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12303 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12304 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12305 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12306
12307 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12308 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12309 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12310 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12311 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012312 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012313 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012314 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12315 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012316 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12317 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012318
12319 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12320 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12321 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12322 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012323 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012324 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12325
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012326 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012327
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012328
12329timeout server-fin <timeout>
12330 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12332 yes | no | yes | yes
12333 Arguments :
12334 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12335 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12336 as explained at the top of this document.
12337
12338 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12339 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12340 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12341 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12342 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12343 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12344 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12345 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12346 situations, it should not be needed.
12347
12348 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12349 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12350 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12351
12352 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12353
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012354
12355timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012356 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12358 yes | yes | yes | yes
12359 Arguments :
12360 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12361 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12362 as explained at the top of this document.
12363
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012364 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12365 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12366 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012367
12368 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12369 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12370 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12371 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012372 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012373
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012374 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012375
12376
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012377timeout tunnel <timeout>
12378 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12380 yes | no | yes | yes
12381 Arguments :
12382 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12383 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12384 as explained at the top of this document.
12385
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012386 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012387 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12388 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12389 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012390 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12391 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012392 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12393 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12394 specified.
12395
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012396 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12397 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12398 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12399 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12400 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12401 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12402 state.
12403
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012404 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12405 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12406 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12407 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012408 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012409
12410 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12411 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12412 forget about it.
12413
12414 Example :
12415 defaults http
12416 option http-server-close
12417 timeout connect 5s
12418 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012419 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012420 timeout server 30s
12421 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12422
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012423 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012424
12425
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012426transparent (deprecated)
12427 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012429 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012430 Arguments : none
12431
12432 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12433 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12434 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12435 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12436 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12437 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12438 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12439 appropriate server.
12440
12441 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12442
12443 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12444 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12445
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012446 See also: "option transparent"
12447
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012448unique-id-format <string>
12449 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12451 yes | yes | yes | no
12452 Arguments :
12453 <string> is a log-format string.
12454
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012455 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12456 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12457 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12458 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012459
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012460 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12461 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12462 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12463 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12464 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12465 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12466 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12467 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012468
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012469 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12470 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012471
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012472 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012473
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012474 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012475
12476 will generate:
12477
12478 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12479
12480 See also: "unique-id-header"
12481
12482unique-id-header <name>
12483 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12485 yes | yes | yes | no
12486 Arguments :
12487 <name> is the name of the header.
12488
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012489 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12490 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012491
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012492 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012493
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012494 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012495 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12496
12497 will generate:
12498
12499 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12500
12501 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012502
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012503use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012504 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12506 no | yes | yes | no
12507 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012508 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12509 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012510
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012511 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12512 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012513
12514 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12515 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12516 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012517 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012518 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012519 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12520 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012521
12522 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12523 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12524 assign the backend.
12525
12526 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12527 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12528 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12529 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12530 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12531 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12532
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012533 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012534 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012535 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12536 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12537 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12538
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012539 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12540 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12541 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12542 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12543 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12544 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12545 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12546 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12547 cannot be forced from the request.
12548
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012549 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012550 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12551 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12552
12553 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12554 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012555
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012556use-fcgi-app <name>
12557 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12559 no | no | yes | yes
12560 Arguments :
12561 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12562
12563 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012564
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012565use-server <server> if <condition>
12566use-server <server> unless <condition>
12567 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12569 no | no | yes | yes
12570 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012571 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12572 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012573
12574 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12575
12576 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12577 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12578 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12579
12580 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12581 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12582 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12583 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12584 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12585 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12586 matches will assign the server.
12587
12588 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12589 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12590 with the next rules until one matches.
12591
12592 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12593 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12594 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12595 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12596
12597 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12598 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12599 stripped.
12600
12601 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12602 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012603 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12604 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12605 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012606
12607 Example :
12608 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12609 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12610 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12611 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012612 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012613 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012614 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012615 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12616 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12617
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012618 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12619 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12620 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12621 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012622 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012623 and we fall back to load balancing.
12624
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012625 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012626
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012627
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100126285. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012629--------------------------
12630
12631The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12632depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12633settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12634written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12635described in this section.
12636
12637
126385.1. Bind options
12639-----------------
12640
12641The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12642as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12643no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12644parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12645while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12646provided immediately after the setting name.
12647
12648The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12649
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012650accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12651 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12652 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12653 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12654 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12655 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12656 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12657 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12658 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12659 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012660 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12661 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12662 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012664accept-proxy
12665 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012666 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12667 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012668 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12669 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12670 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12671 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012672 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012673 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12674 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012675 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12676 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012677
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012678allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012679 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012680 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012681 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012682 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12683 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012684
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012685alpn <protocols>
12686 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12687 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12688 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012689 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012690 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012691 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12692 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12693 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12694 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12695 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12696 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12697 preference, like below :
12698
12699 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012700
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012701backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012702 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012703 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12704
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012705curves <curves>
12706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12707 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12708 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12709 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12710 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12711 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12712
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012713ecdhe <named curve>
12714 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012715 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12716 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012717
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012718ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012719 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12720 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12721 client's certificate.
12722
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012723ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12724 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12725 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12726 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12727 error is ignored.
12728
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012729ca-sign-file <cafile>
12730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12731 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12732 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12733 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12734 'generate-certificates' for details.
12735
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012736ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012737 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12738 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12739 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12740 'generate-certificates' for details.
12741
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012742ca-verify-file <cafile>
12743 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12744 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12745 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12746 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12747 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012749ciphers <ciphers>
12750 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12751 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012752 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012753 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012754 information and recommendations see e.g.
12755 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12756 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12757 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12758
12759ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12761 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12762 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12763 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012764 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12765 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012766
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012767crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012768 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12769 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12770 to verify client's certificate.
12771
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012772crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12774 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12775 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12776 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12777 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012778 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12779 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012780
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012781 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12782 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12783
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012784 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12785 are loaded.
12786
12787 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012788 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12789 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12790 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12791 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12792 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12793 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12794 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012795 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012796
12797 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12798 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12799 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12800 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012801 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12802 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012803
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012804 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012805
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012806 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012807 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012808 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12809 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012810 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12811 clients).
12812
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012813 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12814 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12815 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12816 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12817 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12818 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12819 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12820 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12821 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12822 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12823 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12824 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12825 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12826
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012827 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12828 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12829 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12830 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12831 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12832
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012833 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12834 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12835 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12836 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012837
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012838 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12839 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12840 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012841
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012842crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012844 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012845 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012846 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012847
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012848crt-list <file>
12849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012850 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12851 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012852
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012853 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12854
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012855 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12856 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12857 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12858 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12859 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012860
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012861 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012862 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12863 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12864 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12865 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12866 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012867 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12868 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12869 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012870
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012871 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12872 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12873 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012874
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012875 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12876
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012877 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12878 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12879 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12880 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12881 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12882 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12883 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12884 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012885
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012886 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012887 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012888 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012889 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012890 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012891 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012892
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012893defer-accept
12894 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12895 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12896 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012897 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012898 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12899 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12900 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12901 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12902 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12903 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12904 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12905
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012906expose-fd listeners
12907 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12908 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012909 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12910 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012911 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012912
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012913force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012914 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012915 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012916 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012917 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012918
12919force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012920 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012921 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012922 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012923
12924force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012925 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012926 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012927 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012928
12929force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012930 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012931 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012932 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012933
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012934force-tlsv13
12935 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12936 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012937 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012938
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012939generate-certificates
12940 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12941 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12942 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12943 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12944 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12945 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12946 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12947 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12948 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12949 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12950 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12951
12952 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12953 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012954 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012955 certificate is used many times.
12956
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012957gid <gid>
12958 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12959 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12960 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12961 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12962 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12963
12964group <group>
12965 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12966 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12967 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12968 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12969 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12970
12971id <id>
12972 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12973 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12974 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12975 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12976
12977interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012978 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12979 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12980 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12981 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12982 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12983 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012984 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12985 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12986 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12987 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12988 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12989 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012990
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012991level <level>
12992 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12993 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12994 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012995 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012996 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12997 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12998 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012999 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013000 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013001 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013002 all counters).
13003
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013004severity-output <format>
13005 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13006 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13007 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13008 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13009 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13010 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13011 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13012 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13013 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13014 rfc5424 convention.
13015
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013016maxconn <maxconn>
13017 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13018 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13019 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13020 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13021 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13022 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13023 eat all memory.
13024
13025mode <mode>
13026 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13027 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13028 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13029 UNIX sockets.
13030
13031mss <maxseg>
13032 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13033 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13034 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13035 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13036 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13037 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13038 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13039 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13040 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13041 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13042 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13043
13044name <name>
13045 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13046 page.
13047
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013048namespace <name>
13049 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13050 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13051 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13052 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13053
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013054nice <nice>
13055 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13056 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13057 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13058 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13059 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13060 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13061 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13062 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13063 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13064 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13065 one for an RDP socket.
13066
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013067no-ca-names
13068 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13069 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013070 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013071
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013072no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013073 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013074 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013075 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013076 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013077 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13078 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013079
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013080no-tls-tickets
13081 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13082 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13083 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013084 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13085 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013086 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13087 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13088 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013089
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013090no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013092 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013093 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013094 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013095 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13096 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013097
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013098no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013100 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013101 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013102 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013103 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13104 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013105
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013106no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013107 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013108 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013109 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013110 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013111 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13112 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013113
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013114no-tlsv13
13115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13116 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13117 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13118 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013119 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13120 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013121
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013122npn <protocols>
13123 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13124 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13125 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013126 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013127 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013128 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13129 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13130 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13131 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13132 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013133
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013134prefer-client-ciphers
13135 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13136 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13137 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013138 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13139 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13140 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013141
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013142process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013143 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013144 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013145 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013146 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13147 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13148 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13149 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013150 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013151 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13152 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13153 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13154 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13155 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013156
13157 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13158
13159 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13160 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13161 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13162 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13163 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13164 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13165 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13166 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013167
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013168proto <name>
13169 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13170 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13171 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13172 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013173 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013174 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013175 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013176 h2" on the bind line.
13177
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013178ssl
13179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013180 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013181 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13182 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013183 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13184 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013185
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013186ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13187 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013188 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13189 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13190 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013191 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13192
13193ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013194 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13195 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13196 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13197 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013198
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013199strict-sni
13200 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13201 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13202 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13203 See the "crt" option for more information.
13204
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013205tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013206 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013207 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13208 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013209 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013210 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13211 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13212 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13213 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13214 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13215 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13216 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13217
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013218tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013219 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013220 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13221 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13222 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13223 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13224 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13225 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13226 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013227 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13228 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13229 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013230
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013231tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13232 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013233 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13234 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13235 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13236 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13237 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13238 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13239 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13240 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13241 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13242 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013243 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13244 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13245
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013246transparent
13247 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13248 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13249 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13250 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13251 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13252 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13253 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13254 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13255 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13256 so check for support with your vendor.
13257
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013258v4v6
13259 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13260 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13261 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13262 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013263 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013264
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013265v6only
13266 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13267 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13268 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013269 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13270 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013271
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013272uid <uid>
13273 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13274 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13275 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13276 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13277 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13278
13279user <user>
13280 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13281 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13282 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13283 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13284 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13285
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013286verify [none|optional|required]
13287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13288 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13289 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13290 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13291 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013292 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13293 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13294 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13295 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200132975.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013298------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013300The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13301which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13302arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13303settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13304after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13305Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13306address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013308 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013309 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013310
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013311Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13312keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013314The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013315
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013316addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013317 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013318 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13319 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13320 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13321 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13322 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013323
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013324agent-check
13325 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013326 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013327 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13328 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13329 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013330
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013331 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013332 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013333 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13334 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13335 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013336
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013337 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13338 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13339 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13340 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13341 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013342
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013343 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013344 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013345
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013346 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13347 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13348 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013349
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013350 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13351 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13352 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013353
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013354 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013355 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13356 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13357 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13358 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013359 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013360 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013361
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013362 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13363 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013364
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013365 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13366 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13367 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13368 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13369 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13370 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13371 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13372 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13373 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013374
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013375 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13376 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013377 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13378 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13379 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013380 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013381
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013382 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013383 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013384
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013385agent-send <string>
13386 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13387 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13388 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13389 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13390 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13391
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013392agent-inter <delay>
13393 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13394 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13395
13396 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13397 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13398 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13399 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13400 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13401 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13402 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13403 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13404 of backends use the same servers.
13405
13406 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13407
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013408agent-addr <addr>
13409 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13410
13411 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13412 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13413 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13414 hostname, it will be resolved.
13415
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013416agent-port <port>
13417 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13418
13419 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13420
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013421allow-0rtt
13422 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013423 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13424 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013425
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013426alpn <protocols>
13427 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13428 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13429 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013430 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013431 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13432 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13433 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13434 now obsolete NPN extension.
13435 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13436 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13437
13438 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013440backup
13441 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13442 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13443 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13444 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013445 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13446 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013447
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013448ca-file <cafile>
13449 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13450 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13451 server's certificate.
13452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013453check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013454 This option enables health checks on a server:
13455 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13456 considered available.
13457 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13458 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13459 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13460 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13461 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13462 set.
13463 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13464 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13465 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13466 exchanges succeed.
13467
13468 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13469 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13470 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13471 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13472 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013473 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013474 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13475
13476 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13477 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13478
13479 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13480 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13481
13482 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13483 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13484 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13485 available.
13486
13487 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13488 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13489 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13490
13491 Example:
13492 # simple tcp check
13493 backend foo
13494 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13495 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13496 backend foo
13497 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13498 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13499 backend foo
13500 option tcp-check
13501 tcp-check connect
13502 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013503
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013504check-send-proxy
13505 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13506 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13507 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13508 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13509 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13510 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13511 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13512
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013513check-alpn <protocols>
13514 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13515 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13516 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13517
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013518check-proto <name>
13519 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13520 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13521 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13522 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013523 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013524 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13525 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13526
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013527check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013528 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013529 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13530 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013531
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013532check-ssl
13533 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13534 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13535 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13536 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013537 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013538 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13539 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013540 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013541 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13542 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013543
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013544check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013545 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013546 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13547 for normal traffic.
13548
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013549ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13551 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13552 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013553 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13554 information and recommendations see e.g.
13555 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13556 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13557 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013558
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013559ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13561 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13562 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13563 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013564 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13565 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13566 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013568cookie <value>
13569 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13570 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13571 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13572 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13573 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13574 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13575 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13576
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013577crl-file <crlfile>
13578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13579 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13580 to verify server's certificate.
13581
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013582crt <cert>
13583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13584 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13585 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13586 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13587 certificate request.
13588
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013589disabled
13590 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13591 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13592 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13593 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13594 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013595 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013596
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013597enabled
13598 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13599 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13600 default value.
13601 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13602 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013604error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013605 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13606 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13607 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013609 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013611fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013612 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13613 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13614 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13615
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013616force-sslv3
13617 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13618 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013619 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013620 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013621
13622force-tlsv10
13623 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013624 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013625 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013626
13627force-tlsv11
13628 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013629 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013630 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013631
13632force-tlsv12
13633 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013634 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013635 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013636
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013637force-tlsv13
13638 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13639 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013640 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013642id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013643 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13644 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13645 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013646
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013647init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13648 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13649 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013650 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013651 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13652 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13653 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13654 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13655 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13656 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13657 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13658 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13659 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013660 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013661 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13662 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13663 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13664 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13665 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13666 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013667 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013668
13669 Example:
13670 defaults
13671 # never fail on address resolution
13672 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013674inter <delay>
13675fastinter <delay>
13676downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013677 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13678 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13679 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13680 between checks depending on the server state :
13681
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013682 Server state | Interval used
13683 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13684 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13685 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13686 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13687 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13688 or yet unchecked. |
13689 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13690 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13691 | "inter" otherwise.
13692 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013694 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13695 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13696 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13697 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013698 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13699 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13700 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13701 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13702 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013703
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013704log-proto <logproto>
13705 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13706 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13707 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13708 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013710maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013711 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13712 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013713 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13714 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013715 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13716 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13717 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13718 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13719
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013720 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13721 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13722 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13723 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13724 than 50 concurrent requests.
13725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013726maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013727 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13728 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13729 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13730 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013731 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13732 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13733 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13734 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13735 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13736 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13737 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013738
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013739max-reuse <count>
13740 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13741 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13742 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13743 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13744 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13745 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13746 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13747 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013749minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013750 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13751 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13752 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13753 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13754 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13755 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013756 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013757 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013758
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013759namespace <name>
13760 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13761 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13762 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13763 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13764
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013765no-agent-check
13766 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13767 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13768 default value.
13769 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13770 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13771
13772no-backup
13773 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13774 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13775 default value.
13776 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13777 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13778
13779no-check
13780 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13781 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13782 default value.
13783 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13784 "default-server" "check" setting.
13785
13786no-check-ssl
13787 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13788 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13789 default value.
13790 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13791 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13792
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013793no-send-proxy
13794 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13795 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13796 default value.
13797 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13798 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13799
13800no-send-proxy-v2
13801 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13802 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13803 default value.
13804 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13805 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13806
13807no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13808 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13809 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13810 default value.
13811 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13812 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13813
13814no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13815 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13816 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13817 default value.
13818 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13819 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13820
13821no-ssl
13822 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13823 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13824 default value.
13825 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13826 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13827
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013828 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13829 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13830 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13831
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013832no-ssl-reuse
13833 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13834 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13835 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13836 and for paranoid users.
13837
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013838no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013839 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13840 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013841 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013842
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013843 Supported in default-server: No
13844
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013845no-tls-tickets
13846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13847 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13848 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013849 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13850 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013851 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13852 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13853 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013854 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013855
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013856no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013857 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013858 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13859 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013860 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13861 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013862 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013863
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013864 Supported in default-server: No
13865
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013866no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013867 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013868 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13869 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013870 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13871 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013872 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013873
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013874 Supported in default-server: No
13875
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013876no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013877 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013878 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13879 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013880 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13881 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013882 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013883
13884 Supported in default-server: No
13885
13886no-tlsv13
13887 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13888 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13889 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13890 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13891 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013892 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013893
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013894 Supported in default-server: No
13895
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013896no-verifyhost
13897 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13898 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13899 default value.
13900 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13901 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013902
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013903no-tfo
13904 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13905 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13906 default value.
13907 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13908 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13909
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013910non-stick
13911 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13912 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13913 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13914
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013915npn <protocols>
13916 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13917 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13918 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013919 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013920 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13921 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13922 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013924observe <mode>
13925 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13926 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13927 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13928 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13929 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13930 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013931 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013932
13933 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013935on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013936 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13937 Currently, four modes are available:
13938 - fastinter: force fastinter
13939 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13940 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13941 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13942 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13943
13944 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13945
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013946on-marked-down <action>
13947 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13948 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013949 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13950 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13951 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13952 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13953 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13954 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13955 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13956 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013957
13958 Actions are disabled by default
13959
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013960on-marked-up <action>
13961 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13962 Currently one action is available:
13963 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13964 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13965 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13966 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013967 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13968 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013969 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13970 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13971
13972 Actions are disabled by default
13973
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013974pool-low-conn <max>
13975 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13976 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13977 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13978 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13979 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13980 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13981 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13982 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13983 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13984 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13985 applying to "http-reuse".
13986
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013987pool-max-conn <max>
13988 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13989 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13990 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13991 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13992 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13993 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13994
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013995pool-purge-delay <delay>
13996 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013997 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013998 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014000port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014001 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
14002 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
14003 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
14004 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
14005 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
14006 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
14007
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014008proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014009 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14010 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14011 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14012 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014013 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014014 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014016redir <prefix>
14017 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14018 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14019 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14020 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14021 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14022 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14023 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14024 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014025 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014026 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014027 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14028 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14029 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14030 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14031
14032 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014034rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014035 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14036 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14037 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14038
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014039resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14040 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14041 server.
14042
14043 Available options:
14044
14045 * allow-dup-ip
14046 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14047 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14048 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14049 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14050 For such case, simply enable this option.
14051 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14052
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014053 * ignore-weight
14054 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14055 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14056 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14057
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014058 * prevent-dup-ip
14059 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14060 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14061 same fqdn.
14062 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14063
14064 Example:
14065 backend b_myapp
14066 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14067 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14068 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14069
14070 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14071 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14072 it
14073 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14074 different address
14075
14076 Default value: not set
14077
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014078resolve-prefer <family>
14079 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14080 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14081 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14082 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14083
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014084 Default value: ipv6
14085
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014086 Example:
14087
14088 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014089
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014090resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014091 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014092 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014093 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014094 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14095 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014096 configured network, another address is selected.
14097
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014098 Example:
14099
14100 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014101
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014102resolvers <id>
14103 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14104 hostname.
14105
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014106 Example:
14107
14108 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014109
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014110 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014111
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014112send-proxy
14113 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14114 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14115 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14116 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014117 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14118 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14119 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14120 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14121 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14122 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14123 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14124 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14125 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14126 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014127 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14128 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014129
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014130send-proxy-v2
14131 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14132 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14133 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14134 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014135 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14136 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14137 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14138 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014139
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014140proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014141 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14142 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14143
14144 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14145 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14146 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14147 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14148 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14149 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14150 connection is supported).
14151 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14152 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14153 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14154 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14155 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14156 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14157 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014158
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014159send-proxy-v2-ssl
14160 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14161 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14162 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14163 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14164 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14165 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14166 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014167 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14168 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014169
14170send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14171 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14172 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14173 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14174 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14175 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14176 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14177 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14178 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014179 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14180 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014182slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014183 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14184 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14185 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14186 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14187 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14188 parameters :
14189
14190 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14191 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14192
14193 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14194 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14195 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14196 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14197
14198 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14199 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14200 seen as failed.
14201
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014202sni <expression>
14203 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14204 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14205 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14206 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014207 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14208 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014209 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014210 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14211 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014212
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014213source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014214source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014215source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014216 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14217 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14218 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14219 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14220
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014221 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14222 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14223 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14224 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14225 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14226 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14227 server.
14228
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014229 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14230 specifying the source address without port(s).
14231
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014232ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014233 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14234 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14235 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14236 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14237 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14238 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014239 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14240 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014241
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014242ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14243 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14244 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14245 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14246
14247ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14248 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14249 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14250 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14251
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014252ssl-reuse
14253 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14254 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14255 default value.
14256 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14257 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14258
14259stick
14260 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14261 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14262 default value.
14263 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14264 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014265
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014266socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014267 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014268 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14269 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14270
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014271tcp-ut <delay>
14272 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14273 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14274 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014275 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014276 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14277 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14278 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14279 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14280 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14281 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14282 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14283 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14284 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14285
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014286tfo
14287 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14288 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14289 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14290 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14291 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014292 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014294track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014295 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14296 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14297 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14298 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014299 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14300
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014301tls-tickets
14302 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14303 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14304 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014305 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14306 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14307 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014308 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014309 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014310
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014311verify [none|required]
14312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014313 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014314 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14315 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014316 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014317 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14318 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14319 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14320 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14321 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14322 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14323 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14324 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014325
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014326verifyhost <hostname>
14327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014328 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14329 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14330 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14331 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14332 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14333 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14334 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14335 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014337weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014338 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14339 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14340 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014341 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14342 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14343 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14344 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14345 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14346 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014347
14348
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143495.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14350-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014351
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014352HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14353using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14354configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014355This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14356can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14357workload.
14358This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14359resolution at run time.
14360Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14361carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14362
14363
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143645.3.1. Global overview
14365----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014366
14367As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14368different steps of the process life:
14369
14370 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14371 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14372 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14373
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014374 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14375 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014376
14377A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14378 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14379 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14380 resolution to know this new IP.
14381
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014382When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014383HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014384SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14385from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14386will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14387will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014388
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014389A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014390 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014391 first valid response.
14392
14393 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14394 servers return an error.
14395
14396
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200143975.3.2. The resolvers section
14398----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014399
14400This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014401HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14402contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014403
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014404When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14405uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14406is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14407answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14408
14409When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014410used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014411
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014412 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14413 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14414 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014415
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014416 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14417 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014418
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014419 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14420 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14421 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014422
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014423For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14424following scenarios are possible:
14425
14426 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14427 ignored
14428
14429 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14430 applied
14431
14432 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14433 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14434
14435 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14436 retries the query with a new type
14437
14438 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14439 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014440
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014441As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14442a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014443<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014444
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014445
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014446resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014447 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014448
14449A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14450
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014451accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014452 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014453 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014454 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14455 by RFC 6891)
14456
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014457 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14458
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014459nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14460 DNS server description:
14461 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14462 <ip> : IP address of the server
14463 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14464
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014465parse-resolv-conf
14466 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14467 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14468 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14469
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014470hold <status> <period>
14471 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14472 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014473 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014474 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014475 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14476 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14477 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14478
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014479 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014480
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014481resolve_retries <nb>
14482 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14483 giving up.
14484 Default value: 3
14485
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014486 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14487 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14488 type.
14489
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014490timeout <event> <time>
14491 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14492 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14493 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014494 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14495 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014496 Default value: 1s
14497 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014498 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014499 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014500 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14501 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14502
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014503 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014504
14505 resolvers mydns
14506 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14507 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014508 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014509 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014510 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014511 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014512 hold other 30s
14513 hold refused 30s
14514 hold nx 30s
14515 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014516 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014517 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014518
14519
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200145206. Cache
14521---------
14522
14523HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14524(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14525RAM.
14526
14527The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14528this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14529
14530If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14531independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14532when we try to allocate a new one.
14533
14534The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14535
14536It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14537"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14538for more details.
14539
14540When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14541replaced by "<CACHE>".
14542
14543
145446.1. Limitation
14545----------------
14546
14547The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14548
14549- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014550- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14551 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14552 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014553- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14554- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014555- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14556 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14557 headers)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014558
14559- If the request is not a GET
14560- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14561- If the request contains an Authorization header
14562
14563
145646.2. Setup
14565-----------
14566
14567To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14568the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14569
14570
145716.2.1. Cache section
14572---------------------
14573
14574cache <name>
14575 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14576 size of cache is mandatory.
14577
14578total-max-size <megabytes>
14579 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14580 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14581
14582max-object-size <bytes>
14583 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14584 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14585 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14586
14587max-age <seconds>
14588 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14589 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14590 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14591 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14592 default.
14593
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014594process-vary <0 or 1>
14595 Disable or enable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
14596 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14597 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14598 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
14599 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is 0 (disabled).
14600
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014601
146026.2.2. Proxy section
14603---------------------
14604
14605http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14606 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14607 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14608 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14609 after this one.
14610
14611http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14612 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14613 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14614 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14615 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14616
14617
14618Example:
14619
14620 backend bck1
14621 mode http
14622
14623 http-request cache-use foobar
14624 http-response cache-store foobar
14625 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14626
14627 cache foobar
14628 total-max-size 4
14629 max-age 240
14630
14631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146327. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14633----------------------------------
14634
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014635HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014636client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14637The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14638these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14639but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14640data called patterns.
14641
14642
146437.1. ACL basics
14644---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014645
14646The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14647content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14648from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14649simple :
14650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014651 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014652 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014653 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14654 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014656The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14657adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014658
14659In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014661 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014662
14663This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14664Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14665and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014666an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14667conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14668as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14669are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014670
14671ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14672'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14673which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14674
14675There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14676performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014678The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14679specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14680this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014681methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14682ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014683
14684Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14685 - boolean
14686 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14687 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14688 - string
14689 - data block
14690
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014691Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14692converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14693would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14694The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14695which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14696
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014697Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14698keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14699fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14700which are summarized in the table below :
14701
14702 +---------------------+-----------------+
14703 | Sample or converter | Default |
14704 | output type | matching method |
14705 +---------------------+-----------------+
14706 | boolean | bool |
14707 +---------------------+-----------------+
14708 | integer | int |
14709 +---------------------+-----------------+
14710 | ip | ip |
14711 +---------------------+-----------------+
14712 | string | str |
14713 +---------------------+-----------------+
14714 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14715 +---------------------+-----------------+
14716
14717Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14718matching method, see below.
14719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014720The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14721 - boolean
14722 - integer or integer range
14723 - IP address / network
14724 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14725 - regular expression
14726 - hex block
14727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014728The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14729
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014730 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14731 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014732 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014733 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014734 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014735 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014736 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014738The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14739read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14740if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14741lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14742will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14743beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14744a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14745lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14746exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14747
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014748The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14749parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14750ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14751a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14752check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14753
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014754The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14755socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14756file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014758Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14759loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14760
14761 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14762
14763In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14764the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14765case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14766as well.
14767
14768The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14769sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14770do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14771methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14772is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014773obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14775default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14776that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14777string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14778
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014779The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14780By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14781string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14782resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14783server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014784waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014785flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14786function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14789sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14790be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014791
14792 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14793 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014794 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14795 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14796 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14797 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014798
14799 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14800 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014802
14803 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014805
14806 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014808
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014809 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014810 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14811
14812 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14813 binary or string samples.
14814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14816 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014818 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14819 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14820 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14823 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14826 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014828 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14829 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14832 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014833 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014835 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14836 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14837 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014838
14839For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14840request, it is possible to do :
14841
14842 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14843
14844In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14845buffer, one would use the following acl :
14846
14847 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14848
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014849On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14850possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14851
14852 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14855criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14856method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14857to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14858criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14859the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014861If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014862the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14863For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014865 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14866 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14867 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14868 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014869
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014870
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014871The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14872types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14873combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14874brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14875default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877 +-------------------------------------------------+
14878 | Input sample type |
14879 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014880 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014881 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14882 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14883 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014884 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014885 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014886 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014887 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014888 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014889 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014890 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014891 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014892 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014894 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014895 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014896 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014897 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014898 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014899 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014900 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014901 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014902 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014903 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014904 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014905 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14906 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14907 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014908
14909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149107.1.1. Matching booleans
14911------------------------
14912
14913In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14914Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14915When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14916that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14917
14918Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14919return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14920"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14921
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149237.1.2. Matching integers
14924------------------------
14925
14926Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14927enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14928to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14929
14930Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14931matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14932lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014933
14934For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14935unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14936representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14937
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014938As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14939two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14940instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14941ranges and operators.
14942
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014943For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014944operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14945Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14946of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014947
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014948Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014949
14950 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14951 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14952 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14953 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14954 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014956For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014957
14958 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14959
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014960This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14961
14962 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14963
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149657.1.3. Matching strings
14966-----------------------
14967
14968String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14969different forms :
14970
14971 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014972 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014973
14974 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014975 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014976
14977 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14978 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14979
14980 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14981 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14982
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014983 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014984 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14985 matches.
14986
14987 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14988 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14989 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014990
14991String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14992exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14993characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14994string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14995to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014996before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014997
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014998Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14999(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15000Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15001
15002Example:
15003 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15004 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150077.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15008---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015009
15010Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15011they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15012possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15013passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15014the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015015the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15016match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015017
15018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150197.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15020-------------------------------------
15021
15022It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15023not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15024a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15025to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15026digits may be used upper or lower case.
15027
15028Example :
15029 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15030 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15031
15032
150337.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15034---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015035
15036IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15037netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15038within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015039host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015040difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15041at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15042does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15043parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015044
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015045The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15046abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15047
15048 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15049 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15050 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15051 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15052 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15053 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15054 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15055 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15056
15057Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15058192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15059
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015060IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15061Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15062trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15063IPv6 patterns.
15064
15065HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15066following situations :
15067 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15068 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15069 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15070 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15071 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15072 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15073 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15074 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15075 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15076 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078
150797.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15080----------------------------------
15081
15082Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15083combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15084
15085 - AND (implicit)
15086 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15087 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015089A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015091 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15094indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015096For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15097"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15098requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15099is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15100
15101 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015102 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15103 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15104 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015105
15106To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15107and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15108
15109 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15110 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15111 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15112 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15113
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015114 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015115 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15116 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15117 use_backend www if host_www
15118
15119It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15120expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15121be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15122the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15123
15124 The following rule :
15125
15126 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015127 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128
15129 Can also be written that way :
15130
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015131 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132
15133It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15134to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15135simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15136sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15137good use is the following :
15138
15139 With named ACLs :
15140
15141 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15142 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15143 monitor fail if site_dead
15144
15145 With anonymous ACLs :
15146
15147 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15148
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015149See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15150keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015151
15152
151537.3. Fetching samples
15154---------------------
15155
15156Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15157against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15158sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15159ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15160of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15161available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15162
15163This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15164Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15165compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15166deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15167
15168The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15169matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15170method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15171indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15172
15173As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15174when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15175mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15176the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15177ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15178
15179Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15180multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15181when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015182incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15183are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015184is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15185all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15186
15187Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15188 - name
15189 - name(arg1)
15190 - name(arg1,arg2)
15191
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015192
151937.3.1. Converters
15194-----------------
15195
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015196Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15197of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15198is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15199was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015200has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015201unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15202
15203These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15204sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15205the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015206support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015207
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015208A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15209support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15210supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15211(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15212bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015214The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015215
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001521651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15217 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15218 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15219 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15220 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15221 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15222
15223 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015224 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15225 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015226 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15227 frontend http-in
15228 bind *:8081
15229 default_backend servers
15230 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15231 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15232
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015233add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015234 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015235 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015236 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15237 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015238 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015239 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15240 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15241 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15242 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015243 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015244 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015245
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015246aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15247 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15248 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15249 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15250 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15251 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15252 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15253
15254 Example:
15255 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15256 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15257
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015258and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015259 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015260 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015261 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15262 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015263 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015264 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15265 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15266 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15267 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015268 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015269 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015270
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015271b64dec
15272 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15273 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15274
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015275base64
15276 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015277 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015278 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15279
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015280bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015281 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015282 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015283 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015284 presence of a flag).
15285
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015286bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15287 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15288 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015289 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015290
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015291concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15292 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15293 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15294 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15295 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15296 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15297 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15298 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15299 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15300 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15301 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015302 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015303 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015304 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15305 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015306
15307 Example:
15308 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15309 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15310 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015311 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015312 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15313
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015314cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015315 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15316 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015317
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015318crc32([<avalanche>])
15319 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15320 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15321 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15322 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15323 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15324 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15325 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15326 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15327 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15328 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015329 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15330
15331crc32c([<avalanche>])
15332 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15333 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15334 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15335 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15336 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15337 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15338 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15339 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015340
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015341cut_crlf
15342 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15343 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15344 updated.
15345
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015346da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015347 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15348 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15349 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15350 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015351 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015352 configuration language.
15353
15354 Example:
15355 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015356 bind *:8881
15357 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015358 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015359
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015360debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15361 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15362 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15363 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15364 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15365 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15366 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15367 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15368 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15369 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15370 printable sample types.
15371
15372 Example:
15373 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015374
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015375digest(<algorithm>)
15376 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15377 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15378
15379 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15380 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15381
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015382div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015383 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15384 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015385 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015386 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15387 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015388 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015389 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15390 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15391 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15392 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015393 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015394 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015395
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015396djb2([<avalanche>])
15397 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15398 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15399 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15400 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15401 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15402 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15403 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015404 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15405 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015406
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015407even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015408 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015409 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15410
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015411field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15412 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15413 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15414 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15415 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15416 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15417 fields.
15418
15419 Example :
15420 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15421 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15422 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15423 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15424 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015425
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015426fix_is_valid
15427 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15428 Information eXchange):
15429
15430 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15431 numeric
15432 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valide FIX version
15433 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15434 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15435 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15436 checksum
15437
15438 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15439 the server can be parsed.
15440
15441 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15442 message, false if not.
15443
15444 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15445
15446 Example:
15447 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15448 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15449
15450fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15451 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15452 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15453 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15454 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15455 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15456 added.
15457
15458 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15459 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15460 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15461 fix_is_valid converter.
15462
15463 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15464
15465 Example:
15466 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15467 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15468 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15469 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15470 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15471
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015472hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015473 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015474 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015475 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015476 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015477
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015478hex2i
15479 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015480 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015481
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015482htonl
15483 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15484 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15485 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15486 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15487
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015488hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15489 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15490 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15491 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15492 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15493
15494 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15495 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15496
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015497http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015498 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15499 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015500 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15501 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15502 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15503 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15504 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15505 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15506 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15507 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015509iif(<true>,<false>)
15510 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15511 string otherwise.
15512
15513 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015514 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015515
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015516in_table(<table>)
15517 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15518 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15519 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015520 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015521 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15522
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015523ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15524 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015525 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015526 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15527 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15528 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15529 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15530 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015531
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015532json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015533 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015534 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015535 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015536 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15537 of errors:
15538 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15539 bytes, ...)
15540 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15541 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15542
15543 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15544 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15545 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15546 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15547 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15548 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015549 - "ascii" : never fails;
15550 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15551 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015552 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015553 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015554 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15555 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15556
15557 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015558 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015559
15560 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015561 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015562 capture request header user-agent len 150
15563 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015564
15565 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15566 GET / HTTP/1.0
15567 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15568
15569 Output log:
15570 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15571
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015572language(<value>[,<default>])
15573 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15574 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15575 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15576 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15577 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15578 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15579 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15580 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15581 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015582 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015583 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15584 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015585
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015586 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015587
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015588 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15589 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015590
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015591 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15592 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15593 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15594 use_backend spanish if es
15595 use_backend french if fr
15596 use_backend english if en
15597 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015598
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015599length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015600 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15601 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15602 type. The result is of type integer.
15603
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015604lower
15605 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15606 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15607 type. The result is of type string.
15608
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015609ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15610 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15611 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15612 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15613 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15614 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15615 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15616
15617 Example :
15618
15619 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015620 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015621 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15622
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015623ltrim(<chars>)
15624 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15625 representation of the input sample.
15626
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015627map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15628map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15629map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15630 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15631 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15632 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15633 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15634 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15635 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15636 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15637 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015638
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015639 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15640 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15641 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015642
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015643 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015644 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015645
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015646 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15647 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15648 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15649 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015650 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15651 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015652 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15653 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15654 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15655 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15656 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15657 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15658 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15659 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015660 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15661 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15662 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015663 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15664 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15665 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15666 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15667 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015668
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015669 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15670 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15671 the corresponding match text.
15672
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015673 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15674 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15675 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15676 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15677 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015678
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015679 Example :
15680
15681 # this is a comment and is ignored
15682 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15683 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15684 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15685 | | | `---------- value
15686 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15687 | `---------------------------- key
15688 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15689
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015690mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015691 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15692 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015693 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015694 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015695 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015696 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15697 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15698 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15699 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015700 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015701 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015702
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015703mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15704 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15705 <packettype>.
15706 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15707 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15708 from.
15709 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15710 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15711 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15712
15713 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15714 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15715 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15716 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15717
15718 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15719 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15720 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15721 packets only):
15722 17: Session Expiry Interval
15723 33: Receive Maximum
15724 39: Maximum Packet Size
15725 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15726 25: Request Response Information
15727 23: Request Problem Information
15728 21: Authentication Method
15729 22: Authentication Data
15730 18: Will Delay Interval
15731 1: Payload Format Indicator
15732 2: Message Expiry Interval
15733 3: Content Type
15734 8: Response Topic
15735 9: Correlation Data
15736 Not supported yet:
15737 38: User Property
15738
15739 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15740 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15741 packets only):
15742 17: Session Expiry Interval
15743 33: Receive Maximum
15744 36: Maximum QoS
15745 37: Retain Available
15746 39: Maximum Packet Size
15747 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15748 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15749 31: Reason String
15750 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15751 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15752 42: Shared Subscription Available
15753 19: Server Keep Alive
15754 26: Response Information
15755 28: Server Reference
15756 21: Authentication Method
15757 22: Authentication Data
15758 Not supported yet:
15759 38: User Property
15760
15761 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15762 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15763 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15764 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15765
15766 Example:
15767
15768 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15769 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15770 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15771 if data_in_buffer
15772 # do the same as above
15773 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15774 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15775 if data_in_buffer
15776
15777mqtt_is_valid
15778 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15779
15780 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15781 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15782 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15783 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15784
15785 Example:
15786
15787 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15788 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15789
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015790mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015791 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015792 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15793 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015794 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015795 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015796 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015797 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15798 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15799 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15800 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015801 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015802 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015803
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015804nbsrv
15805 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15806 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15807 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15808 map lookup.
15809
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015810neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015811 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15812 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15813 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15814 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015815
15816not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015817 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015818 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015819 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015820 absence of a flag).
15821
15822odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015823 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015824 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15825
15826or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015827 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015828 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015829 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15830 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015831 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015832 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15833 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15834 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15835 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015836 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015837 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015838
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015839protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15840 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15841 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15842 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15843 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15844 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15845 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15846 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15847 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15848 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15849 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15850 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15851
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015852regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015853 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15854 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15855 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15856 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15857 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15858 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15859 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15860 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15861 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015862 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15863 of characters with other ones.
15864
15865 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15866 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15867 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15868 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15869 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15870 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015871
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015872 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015873
15874 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15875 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15876 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015877 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015878
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015879 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15880 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15881
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015882 # capture groups and backreferences
15883 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015884 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015885 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15886
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015887capture-req(<id>)
15888 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15889 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15890
15891 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015892 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15893 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015894
15895capture-res(<id>)
15896 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15897 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15898
15899 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015900 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15901 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015902
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015903rtrim(<chars>)
15904 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15905 of the input sample.
15906
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015907sdbm([<avalanche>])
15908 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15909 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15910 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15911 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15912 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15913 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15914 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015915 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15916 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015917
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015918secure_memcmp(<var>)
15919 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15920 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15921 match.
15922
15923 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15924 performed in constant time.
15925
15926 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15927 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15928
15929 Example :
15930
15931 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15932 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15933 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15934 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15935
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015936set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015937 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15938 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15939 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015940 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015941 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15942 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015943 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015944 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15945 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015946 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015947 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015948
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015949sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015950 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015951 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15952
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015953sha2([<bits>])
15954 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15955 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15956
15957 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15958 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15959
15960 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15961 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15962
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015963srv_queue
15964 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15965 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15966 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15967 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15968 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15969
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015970strcmp(<var>)
15971 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15972 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15973 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15974 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15975 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15976 shorter).
15977
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015978 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15979 strings in constant time.
15980
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015981 Example :
15982
15983 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15984 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15985 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15986
15987
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015988sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015989 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15990 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015991 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015992 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15993 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015994 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015995 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15996 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015997 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015998 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15999 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016000 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016001 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016002
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016003table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16007 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16008 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16009 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16010
16011
16012table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16016 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16017 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16018 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16019
16020table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16021 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16022 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016023 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016024 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16025 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16026
16027table_conn_cur(<table>)
16028 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16029 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16030 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16031 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16032 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16033
16034table_conn_rate(<table>)
16035 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16036 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16037 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16038 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16039 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16040
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016041table_gpt0(<table>)
16042 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16043 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16044 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16045 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16046 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16047
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016048table_gpc0(<table>)
16049 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16050 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16051 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16052 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16053 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16054
16055table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16056 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16057 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16058 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16059 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16060 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16061 sample fetch keyword.
16062
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016063table_gpc1(<table>)
16064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16067 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16068 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16069
16070table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16071 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16072 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16073 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16074 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16075 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16076 sample fetch keyword.
16077
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016078table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16079 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16080 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016081 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016082 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16083 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16084
16085table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16086 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16087 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16088 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16089 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16090 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16091 keyword.
16092
16093table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016096 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016097 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16098 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16099
16100table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16101 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16102 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16103 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16104 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16105 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16106 keyword.
16107
16108table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16109 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16110 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016111 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016112 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16113 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16114 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16115 keyword.
16116
16117table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16118 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16119 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016120 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016121 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16122 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16123 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16124 keyword.
16125
16126table_server_id(<table>)
16127 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16128 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16129 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16130 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16131 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16132 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16133
16134table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16135 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16136 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016137 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016138 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16139 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16140 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16141 keyword.
16142
16143table_sess_rate(<table>)
16144 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16145 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16146 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16147 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16148 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16149 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16150 keyword.
16151
16152table_trackers(<table>)
16153 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16154 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16155 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16156 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16157 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16158 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16159 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16160 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16161 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16162 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16163
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016164upper
16165 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16166 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16167 type. The result is of type string.
16168
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016169url_dec([<in_form>])
16170 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16171 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16172 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16173 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16174 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16175 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016176
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016177ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016178 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016179 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16180 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16181 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016182 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16183 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16184 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16185 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016186 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016187 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16188 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016189
16190 Example:
16191 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16192 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16193
16194 message Point {
16195 int32 latitude = 1;
16196 int32 longitude = 2;
16197 }
16198
16199 message PPoint {
16200 Point point = 59;
16201 }
16202
16203 message Rectangle {
16204 // One corner of the rectangle.
16205 PPoint lo = 48;
16206 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16207 PPoint hi = 49;
16208 }
16209
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016210 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16211 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16212 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016213
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016214 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16215 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016216 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016217 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16218
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016219 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016220
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016221 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016222
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016223 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16224 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16225 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016226
16227 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16228 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16229 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16230
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016231 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16232 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16233 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016234
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016235
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016236unset-var(<var name>)
16237 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16238 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16239 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16240 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16241 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16242 response),
16243 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16244 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16245 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16246 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16247
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016248utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16249 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16250 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16251 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16252 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16253 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16254 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16255
16256 Example :
16257
16258 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016259 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016260 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16261
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016262word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16263 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16264 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16265 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016266 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016267 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16268 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16269
16270 Example :
16271 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16272 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16273 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16274 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16275 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016276 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016277
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016278wt6([<avalanche>])
16279 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16280 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16281 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16282 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16283 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16284 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16285 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016286 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16287 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016288
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016289xor(<value>)
16290 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016291 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016292 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016293 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016294 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016295 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16296 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016297 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016298 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16299 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016301 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016302
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016303xxh32([<seed>])
16304 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16305 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16306 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16307 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16308 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16309 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16310 as cryptographically secure.
16311
16312xxh64([<seed>])
16313 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16314 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16315 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16316 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16317 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16318 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16319 as cryptographically secure.
16320
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016321
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163227.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323--------------------------------------------
16324
16325A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16326not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16327"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16328The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16329
16330always_false : boolean
16331 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16332 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16333
16334always_true : boolean
16335 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16336 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16337
16338avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016339 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016340 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16341 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16342 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16343 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16344 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16345 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16346 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16347 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16348 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16349 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16350 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16351 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16352 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016354be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016355 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16356 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16357 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16358 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016359 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16360
16361be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16362 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16363 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16364 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16365 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16366 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016367 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16368 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016369
16370 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16371 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16372 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16375 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16376 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16377 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016378 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016379 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16380 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016381
16382 Example :
16383 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16384 backend dynamic
16385 mode http
16386 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16387 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016388
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016389bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016390 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16391 of the string.
16392
16393bool(<bool>) : bool
16394 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16395 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16398 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016399 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016400 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16401 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016402
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016403 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016404 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016405 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16406
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016407 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16408 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016409
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016410 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016411 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016412 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016413 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016414 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016415 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016416 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016417
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016418 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16419 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016421 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016422
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016423cpu_calls : integer
16424 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16425 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16426 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16427 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16428 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16429 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16430
16431cpu_ns_avg : integer
16432 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16433 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16434 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16435 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16436 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16437 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16438 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16439 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16440 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16441 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16442 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16443
16444cpu_ns_tot : integer
16445 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16446 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16447 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16448 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16449 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16450 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16451 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16452 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16453 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16454 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16455 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16456 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16457 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16458
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016459date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016460 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016461
16462 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16463 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16464 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016465 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16466
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016467 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16468 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16469 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16470 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16471 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16472
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016473 Example :
16474
16475 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16476 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016477
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016478 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16479 # millisecond granularity
16480 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16481
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016482date_us : integer
16483 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16484 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16485 from the same timeval structure.
16486
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016487distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16488 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16489 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16490 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16491 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16492 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16493 list of supported tokens.
16494
16495distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16496 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16497 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16498 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16499 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16500 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16501 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16502 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16503 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16504 supported tokens.
16505
16506 Example :
16507 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16508 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16509 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16510 # send large files to the big farm
16511 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16512
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016513env(<name>) : string
16514 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16515 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16516 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16517 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16518 certain way.
16519
16520 Examples :
16521 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16522 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16523
16524 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16525 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016527fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16528 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016529 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16530 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016531 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16532 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016533 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016534 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16535 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016536
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016537fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16538 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16539 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16540 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016542fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16543 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16544 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16545 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16546 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16547 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16548 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16549 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16550 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016551
16552 Example :
16553 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16554 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16555 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16556 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16557 frontend mail
16558 bind :25
16559 mode tcp
16560 maxconn 100
16561 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16562 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16563 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16564 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016565
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016566hostname : string
16567 Returns the system hostname.
16568
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016569int(<integer>) : signed integer
16570 Returns a signed integer.
16571
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016572ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16573 Returns an ipv4.
16574
16575ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16576 Returns an ipv6.
16577
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016578lat_ns_avg : integer
16579 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16580 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16581 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16582 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16583 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16584 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16585 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16586 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16587 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016588 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16589 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16590 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16591 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16592 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16593 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016594
16595lat_ns_tot : integer
16596 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16597 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16598 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16599 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16600 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16601 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16602 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16603 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16604 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016605 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16606 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16607 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16608 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16609 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016610 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16611 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16612 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16613 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16614 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16615 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16616
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016617meth(<method>) : method
16618 Returns a method.
16619
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016620nbproc : integer
16621 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16622 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16623 and debugging purposes.
16624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016625nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16626 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16627 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16628 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016629 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16630 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16631 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016632
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016633prio_class : integer
16634 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16635 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16636 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16637
16638prio_offset : integer
16639 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16640 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16641 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16642 set-priority-offset".
16643
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016644proc : integer
16645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16646 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16647 debugging purposes.
16648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016650 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16651 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16652 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016653 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16654 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16655 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16656 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16657 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16658
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016659rand([<range>]) : integer
16660 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16661 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16662 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16663 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16664 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16665
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016666uuid([<version>]) : string
16667 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16668 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16669 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016671srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16672 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16673 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16674 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16675 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16676 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016677 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16678 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16679
16680srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16681 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16682 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16683 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16684 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16685 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16686 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16687 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16688
16689 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16690 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016691
16692srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16693 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16694 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16695 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016696 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016697 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16698 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16699 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16700
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016701srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16702 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16703 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16704 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16705 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16706 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16707 fetch methods.
16708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016709srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16710 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16711 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016712 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016713 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16714 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016715 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016716 overloading servers).
16717
16718 Example :
16719 # Redirect to a separate back
16720 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16721 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16722 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16723
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016724srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16725 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16726 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16727 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16728
16729srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16730 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16731 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16732 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16733
16734srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16735 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16736 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16737 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16738
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016739stopping : boolean
16740 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16741 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16742 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16743
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016744str(<string>) : string
16745 Returns a string.
16746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016747table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16748 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16749 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16750
16751table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16752 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16753 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16754 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16755
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016756thread : integer
16757 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16758 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16759 and debugging purposes.
16760
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016761var(<var-name>) : undefined
16762 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016763 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16764 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016765 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016766 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16767 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016768 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016769 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16770 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016771 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016772 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016773
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200167747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775----------------------------------
16776
16777The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16778closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16779methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16780sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16781TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016782the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16783counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016784"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16785used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16786can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16787Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16788table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16789tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16790currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016791
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016792bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016793 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16794 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16795 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016797be_id : integer
16798 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016799 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16800 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016802be_name : string
16803 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016804 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16805 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016807dst : ip
16808 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16809 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16810 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16811 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016812 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16813 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16814 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16815 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16816 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16817 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016818
16819dst_conn : integer
16820 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16821 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16822 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16823 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16824 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16825 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16826 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16827 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016828
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016829dst_is_local : boolean
16830 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16831 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16832 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16833 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016834 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016835 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16836 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16837 it only once per connection.
16838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839dst_port : integer
16840 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16841 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16842 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16843 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16844 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16845 an HTTP header.
16846
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016847fc_http_major : integer
16848 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16849 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16850 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16851
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016852fc_pp_authority : string
16853 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16854 if any.
16855
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016856fc_pp_unique_id : string
16857 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16858 if any.
16859
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016860fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16861 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16862 header.
16863
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016864fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16865 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16866 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16867 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16868 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16869 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16870 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16871
16872fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16873 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16874 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16875 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16876 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16877 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16878 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16879
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016880fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016881 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16882 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16883 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16884 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16885
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016886fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016887 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16888 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16889 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16890 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16891
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016892fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016893 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16894 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16895 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16896 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16897
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016898fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016899 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16900 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16901 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16902 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16903
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016904fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016905 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16906 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16907 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16908 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16909
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016910fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016911 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16912 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16913 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16914 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16915
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016916fe_defbe : string
16917 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16918 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920fe_id : integer
16921 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016922 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016923 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16924
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016925fe_name : string
16926 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16927 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16928 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016930sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016931sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16932sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16933sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016934 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16935 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16936 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16937
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016938sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016939sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16940sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16941sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016942 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16943 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16944 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16945
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016946sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016947sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16948sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16949sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016950 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16951 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016952 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16953 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16954 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016955
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016956 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016957 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16958 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016959 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16960 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16961 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016962 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16963 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16964
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016965sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16966sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16967sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16968sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16969 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16970 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16971 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16972 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16973 when a first ACL was verified.
16974
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016975sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016976sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16977sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16978sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016979 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016980 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16981
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016982sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016983sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16984sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16985sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016986 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16987 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16988 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16989
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016990sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016991sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16992sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16993sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016994 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16995 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16996 See also src_conn_rate.
16997
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016998sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016999sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17000sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17001sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017002 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017003 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017004
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017005sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17006sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17007sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17008sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17009 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17010 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17011
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017012sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17013sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17014sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17015sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17016 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17017 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17018
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017019sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017020sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17021sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17022sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017023 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17024 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17025 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017026 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17027 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17028 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017029
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017030sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17031sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17032sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17033sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17034 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17035 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17036 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17037 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17038 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17039 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17040
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017041sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017042sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17043sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17044sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017045 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017046 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17047 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17048
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017049sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017050sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17051sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17052sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017053 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17054 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17055 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17056 src_http_err_rate.
17057
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017058sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017059sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17060sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17061sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017062 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017063 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17064 src_http_req_cnt.
17065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017066sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017067sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17068sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17069sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017070 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17071 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17072 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17073 src_http_req_rate.
17074
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017075sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017076sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17077sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17078sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017079 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017080 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17081 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17082 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17083 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017084
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017085 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017086 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17087 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017088 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17089
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017090sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17091sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17092sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17093sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17094 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17095 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17096 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17097 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17098 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17099
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017100sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017101sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17102sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17103sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017104 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17105 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17106 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017107
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017108sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017109sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17110sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17111sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017112 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17113 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17114 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017115
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017116sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017117sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17118sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17119sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017120 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017121 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17122 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17123 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017124 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017125 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17126
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017127sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017128sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17129sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17130sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017131 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17132 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17133 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17134 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17135 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017136 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017137
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017138sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017139sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17140sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17141sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017142 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17143 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17144 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17145
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017146sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017147sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17148sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17149sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017150 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17151 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017152 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017153 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17154 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017155 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17156 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17157 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017159so_id : integer
17160 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17161 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17162 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017163
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017164so_name : string
17165 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17166 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17167 strings instead of integers.
17168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017169src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017170 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017171 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17172 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17173 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017174 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17175 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17176 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017177 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17178 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17179 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17180 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17181 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17182 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17183 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017184
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017185 Example:
17186 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17187 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017189src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17190 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17191 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17192 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017193 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017195src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17196 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17197 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017198 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017199 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017201src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17202 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17203 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17204 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17205 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17206 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17207 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017208
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017209 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017210 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17211 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17212 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17213 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017214 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017215 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17216 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17217
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017218src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17219 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17220 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17221 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17222 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17223 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17224 was verified.
17225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017226src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017227 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017228 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017229 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017230 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017232src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017233 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017234 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17235 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017236 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017238src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17239 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17240 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17241 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017242 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017244src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017245 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017246 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017247 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017248 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017249
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017250src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17251 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17252 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17253 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17254 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17255
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017256src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17257 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17258 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17259 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17260 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017262src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017263 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017264 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017265 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17266 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017267 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17268 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17269 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017270
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017271src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17272 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17273 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17274 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17275 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17276 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17277 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17278 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017280src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017281 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017282 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017283 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017284 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017287src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17288 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17289 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17290 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17291 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017292 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017294src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017295 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017296 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17297 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017298 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017300src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17301 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17302 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17303 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017304 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017305 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017307src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17308 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17309 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17310 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017311 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017312 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17313 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017314
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017315 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017316 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017317 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017318 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017319
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017320src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17321 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17322 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17323 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17324 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17325 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17326 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17327
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017328src_is_local : boolean
17329 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17330 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17331 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17332 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017333 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017334 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17335 once per connection.
17336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017337src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017338 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17339 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17340 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17341 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17342 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017344src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017345 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17346 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17347 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17348 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17349 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017351src_port : integer
17352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17353 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17354 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17355 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017357src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017358 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017359 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17360 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17361 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017362 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017364src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17365 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17366 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17367 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17368 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017369 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017371src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17372 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17373 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17374 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17375 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17376 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17377 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17378 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17379 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017380
17381 Example :
17382 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17383 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17384 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17385 listen ssh
17386 bind :22
17387 mode tcp
17388 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017389 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017390 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017391 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017393srv_id : integer
17394 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17395 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017396 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017397
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017398srv_name : string
17399 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17400 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017401 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017402
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174037.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017404----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017406The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17407closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17408when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17409usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017410future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017411
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001741251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17413 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17414 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17415 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17416 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17417 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17418
17419 Example :
17420 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17421 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17422 # the request.
17423 frontend http-in
17424 bind *:8081
17425 default_backend servers
17426 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17427 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17428
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017429ssl_bc : boolean
17430 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17431 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017432 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17433 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017434
17435ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17436 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017437 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17438 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017439
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017440ssl_bc_alpn : string
17441 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17442 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017443 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017444 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17445 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17446 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17447 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17448 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017449 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17450 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017451
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017452ssl_bc_cipher : string
17453 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017454 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17455 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017456
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017457ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17458 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17459 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17460 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017461 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017462
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017463ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17464 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17465 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017466 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17467 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017468
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017469ssl_bc_npn : string
17470 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17471 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017472 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017473 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17474 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17475 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17476 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017477 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17478 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017479
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017480ssl_bc_protocol : string
17481 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017482 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17483 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017484
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017485ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017486 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017487 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017488 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17489 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017490
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017491ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17492 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17493 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17494 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017495 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017496
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017497ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17498 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17499 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017500 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17501 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017502
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017503ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17504 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17505 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17506 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017507 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017508
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017509ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17510 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017511 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17512 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017514ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17515 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17516 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17517 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17518 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17519 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017521ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17522 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17523 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17524 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17525 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017526
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017527ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017528 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17529 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17530 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17531 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17532 does not support resumed sessions.
17533
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017534ssl_c_der : binary
17535 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17536 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17537 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017539ssl_c_err : integer
17540 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17541 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17542 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17543 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17544 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017545
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017546ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017547 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17548 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17549 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17550 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17551 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17552 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17553 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17554 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017555 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17556 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17557 LDAP v3.
17558 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17559 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017561ssl_c_key_alg : string
17562 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17563 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17564 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017566ssl_c_notafter : string
17567 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17568 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17569 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017571ssl_c_notbefore : string
17572 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17573 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17574 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017575
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017576ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17578 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17579 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17580 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17581 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17582 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17583 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17584 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017585 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17586 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17587 LDAP v3.
17588 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17589 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017591ssl_c_serial : binary
17592 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17593 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17594 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17597 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17598 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17599 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017600 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17601 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17602
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017603 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017604 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17607 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17608 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17609 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017611ssl_c_used : boolean
17612 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17613 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615ssl_c_verify : integer
17616 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17617 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17618 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17619 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017621ssl_c_version : integer
17622 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17623 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017624
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017625ssl_f_der : binary
17626 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17627 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17628 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17629
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017630ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017631 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17632 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17633 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17634 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017635 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017636 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17637 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17638 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017639 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17640 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17641 LDAP v3.
17642 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17643 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017645ssl_f_key_alg : string
17646 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17647 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17648 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017650ssl_f_notafter : string
17651 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17652 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17653 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017655ssl_f_notbefore : string
17656 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17657 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17658 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017659
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017660ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017661 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17662 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17663 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17664 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17665 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17666 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17667 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17668 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017669 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17670 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17671 LDAP v3.
17672 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17673 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017675ssl_f_serial : binary
17676 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17677 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17678 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017679
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017680ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17681 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17682 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17683 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017685ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17686 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17687 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17688 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017690ssl_f_version : integer
17691 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17692 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17693
17694ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017695 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17696 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17697 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017699 Example :
17700 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17701 listen http-https
17702 bind :80
17703 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17704 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17705
17706ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17707 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17708 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17709
17710ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017711 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017712 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17713 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17714 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17715 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17716 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17717 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17718 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17719 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017721ssl_fc_cipher : string
17722 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17723 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017724
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017725ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17726 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17727 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017728 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017729
17730ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17731 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17732 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017733 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017734
17735ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17736 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17737 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17738 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017739 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017740 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017741
17742ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17743 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17744 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017745 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017746
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017747ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17748 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17749 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17750 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17751
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017752ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17753 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17754 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17755 transport layer.
17756 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17757 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17758 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17759 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17760
17761ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17762 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17763 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17764 transport layer.
17765 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17766 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17767 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17768 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17769
17770ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17771 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17772 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17773 transport layer.
17774 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17775 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17776 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17777 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17778
17779ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17780 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17781 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17782 transport layer.
17783 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17784 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17785 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17786 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17787
17788ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17789 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17790 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17791 transport layer.
17792 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17793 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17794 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17795 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017797ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017798 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17799 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017800 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17801 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17802 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17803 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017804
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017805ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17806 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17807 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17808 wait until the handshake happened.
17809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017810ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17811 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017812 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17813 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017814 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017815 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017816
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017817ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017818 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017819 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17820 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017822ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017823 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017824 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17825 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17826 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17827 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17828 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17829 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17830 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017832ssl_fc_protocol : string
17833 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17834 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017835
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017836ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017837 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017838 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17839 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017840
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017841ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17842 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17843 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17844 transport layer.
17845 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17846 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17847 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17848 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17849
17850ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17851 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17852 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17853 transport layer.
17854 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17855 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17856 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17857 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17858
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017859ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17860 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17861 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17862 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017864ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17865 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17866 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17867 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17868 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017869
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017870ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17871 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17872 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17873 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17874 BoringSSL.
17875
17876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017877ssl_fc_sni : string
17878 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17879 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17880 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17881 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17882 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17883
17884 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17885 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17886 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017887 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017888 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017890 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017891 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17892 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017894ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17895 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17896 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017897
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017898ssl_s_der : binary
17899 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17900 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17901 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17902
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017903ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17904 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17905 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17906 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17907 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17908 does not support resumed sessions.
17909
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017910ssl_s_key_alg : string
17911 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17912 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17913 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17914
17915ssl_s_notafter : string
17916 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17917 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17918 transport layer.
17919
17920ssl_s_notbefore : string
17921 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17922 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17923 transport layer.
17924
17925ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17926 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17927 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17928 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17929 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17930 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17931 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017932 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17933 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017934 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17935 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17936 LDAP v3.
17937 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17938 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17939
17940ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17941 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17942 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17943 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17944 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17945 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17946 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017947 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17948 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017949 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17950 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17951 LDAP v3.
17952 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17953 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17954
17955ssl_s_serial : binary
17956 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17957 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17958 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17959
17960ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17961 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17962 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17963 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17964
17965ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17966 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17967 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17968 layer.
17969
17970ssl_s_version : integer
17971 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17972 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017973
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179747.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017975------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017977Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17978sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17979only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17980For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17981be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17982can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17983sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17984for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17985content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017987payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017988 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017989 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17990 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017992payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17993 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017994 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017995 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017997req.len : integer
17998req_len : integer (deprecated)
17999 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18000 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18001 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18002 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18003 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18004 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18005 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18006 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018008req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18009 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018010 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18011 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18012 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18013 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018015 ACL alternatives :
18016 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018018req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18019 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18020 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18021 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18022 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018024 ACL alternatives :
18025 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018027 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018029req.proto_http : boolean
18030req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18031 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18032 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18033 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18034 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18035 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18036 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18037 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018039 Example:
18040 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18041 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18042 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018043 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018045req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18046rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18047 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18048 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18049 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18050 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18051 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18052 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18053 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018055 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18056 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18057 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18058 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18059 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18060 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018062 ACL derivatives :
18063 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018065 Example :
18066 listen tse-farm
18067 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18068 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18069 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18070 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18071 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18072 persist rdp-cookie
18073 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18074 # This is only useful makes sense if
18075 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18076 stick-table type string size 204800
18077 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18078 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18079 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018081 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18082 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018084req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18085rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18086 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18087 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18088 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18089 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018091 ACL derivatives :
18092 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018093
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018094req.ssl_alpn : string
18095 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18096 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18097 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18098 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18099 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18100 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018101 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018102
18103 Examples :
18104 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18105 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18106 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018107 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018108 default_backend bk_default
18109
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018110req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18111 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18112 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018113 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18114 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18115 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18116 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18117 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018119req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18120req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18121 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18122 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18123 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18124 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18125 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18126 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18127 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018129req.ssl_sni : string
18130req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18131 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18132 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18133 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18134 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18135 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018136 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18137 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18138 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18139 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18140 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18141 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18142 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18143 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18144 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018146 ACL derivatives :
18147 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018149 Examples :
18150 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18151 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18152 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18153 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18154 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018155
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018156req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18157 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18158 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18159 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18160 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18161 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18162 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18163 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18164 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18165 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167req.ssl_ver : integer
18168req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18169 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18170 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18171 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18172 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18173 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18174 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18175 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018176 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018177 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018179 ACL derivatives :
18180 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018181
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018182res.len : integer
18183 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18184 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18185 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18186 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18187 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18188 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18189 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018190 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018192res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18193 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018194 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018195 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018196 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018197 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018199res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18200 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18201 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18202 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018203 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18204 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018206 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018207
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018208res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18209rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18210 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18211 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18212 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18213 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18214 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18215 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18216 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218wait_end : boolean
18219 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18220 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018221 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018222 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18223 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018224 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018225 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18226 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018228 Examples :
18229 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18230 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18231 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018233 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18234 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18235 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18236 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18237 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18238 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18239 tcp-request content reject
18240
18241
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182427.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018243--------------------------------------
18244
18245It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18246This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18247data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18248its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18249HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18250content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18251to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18252more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18253response are indexed.
18254
18255base : string
18256 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18257 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18258 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18259 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18260 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18261 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18262 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18263 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18264
18265 ACL derivatives :
18266 base : exact string match
18267 base_beg : prefix match
18268 base_dir : subdir match
18269 base_dom : domain match
18270 base_end : suffix match
18271 base_len : length match
18272 base_reg : regex match
18273 base_sub : substring match
18274
18275base32 : integer
18276 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18277 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18278 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018279 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18280 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18281 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018282
18283base32+src : binary
18284 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18285 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18286 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18287 per-URL counters.
18288
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018289capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18290 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18291 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18292 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18293
18294capture.req.method : string
18295 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18296 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18297 because it's allocated.
18298
18299capture.req.uri : string
18300 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18301 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18302 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18303 allocated.
18304
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018305capture.req.ver : string
18306 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18307 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18308 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18309
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018310capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18311 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18312 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18313 The first entry is an index of 0.
18314 See also: "capture response header"
18315
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018316capture.res.ver : string
18317 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18318 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18319 persistent flag.
18320
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018321req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018322 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18323 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18324 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018325
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018326req.body_param([<name>) : string
18327 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18328 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18329 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18330 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18331 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18332 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18333 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18334 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18335 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18336 given.
18337
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018338req.body_len : integer
18339 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18340 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018341 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18342 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018343
18344req.body_size : integer
18345 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018346 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18347 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018349req.cook([<name>]) : string
18350cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18351 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18352 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18353 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18354 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18355 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18356 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18357 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18358 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18359
18360 ACL derivatives :
18361 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18362 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18363 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18364 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18365 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18366 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18367 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18368 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018370req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18371cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18372 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18373 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018375req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18376cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18377 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18378 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18379 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18380 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018382cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18383 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18384 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18385 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18386 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018387 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018388 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18389 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18390 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18391 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018393hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18394 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18395 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18396 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18397 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018398 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018400req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
18401 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18402 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18403 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18404 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18405 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18406 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
18407 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
18408 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018410req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18411 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18412 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18413 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18414 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018416req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18417 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18418 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18419 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18420 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18421 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18422 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18423 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18424 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018425 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018426 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018427 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018429 ACL derivatives :
18430 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18431 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18432 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18433 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18434 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18435 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18436 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18437 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18438
18439req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18440hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18441 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18442 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18443 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18444 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18445 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18446 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18447 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18448 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18449 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18450
18451req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18452hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18453 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18454 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18455 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18456 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18457 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018458 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018459 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18460 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18461
18462req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18463hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18464 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18465 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18466 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18467 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18468 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18469 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18470 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18471
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018472req.hdrs : string
18473 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18474 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18475 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18476 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18477
18478req.hdrs_bin : binary
18479 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18480 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18481 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18482 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18483 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18484 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18485
18486 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018487
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018488 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18489 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018491http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18492 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18493 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18494 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18495 basic auth is supported.
18496
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018497http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18498 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18499 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18500 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18501 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018502 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18503 basic auth is supported.
18504
18505 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018506 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18507 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18508 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18509 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018510
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018511http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018512 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18513 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18514 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018515
18516http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018517 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18518 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18519 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018520
18521http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018522 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18523 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18524 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018526http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018527 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18528 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018529 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18530 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018532method : integer + string
18533 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18534 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18535 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18536 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18537 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18538 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18539 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018541 ACL derivatives :
18542 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018544 Example :
18545 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18546 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18547 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018549path : string
18550 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18551 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18552 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18553 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18554 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018555 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018556 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018558 ACL derivatives :
18559 path : exact string match
18560 path_beg : prefix match
18561 path_dir : subdir match
18562 path_dom : domain match
18563 path_end : suffix match
18564 path_len : length match
18565 path_reg : regex match
18566 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018567
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018568pathq : string
18569 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18570 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18571 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18572 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18573 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18574 result in both cases.
18575
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018576query : string
18577 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18578 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18579 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18580 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018581 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018582 which stops before the question mark.
18583
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018584req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18585 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18586 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18587 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18588 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018590req.ver : string
18591req_ver : string (deprecated)
18592 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18593 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18594 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018596 ACL derivatives :
18597 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018598
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018599res.body : binary
18600 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18601 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18602 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18603 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18604
18605res.body_len : integer
18606 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18607 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18608 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18609 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18610
18611res.body_size : integer
18612 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18613 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18614 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18615 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18616 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18617 based expect rules.
18618
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018619res.cache_hit : boolean
18620 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18621 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18622
18623res.cache_name : string
18624 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18625 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18626 empty string.
18627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018628res.comp : boolean
18629 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18630 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18631 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018633res.comp_algo : string
18634 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18635 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18636 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018638res.cook([<name>]) : string
18639scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18640 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18641 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018642 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18643 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018645 ACL derivatives :
18646 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018648res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18649scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18650 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18651 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018652 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18653 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018655res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18656scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18657 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18658 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018659 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18660 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018662res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18663 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18664 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18665 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18666 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18667 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18668 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18669 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18670 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018671 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018673res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18674 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18675 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18676 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18677 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018678 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18679 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018681res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18682shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18683 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18684 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18685 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18686 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18687 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18688 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18689 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018690 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18691 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693 ACL derivatives :
18694 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18695 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18696 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18697 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18698 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18699 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18700 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18701 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18702
18703res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18704shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18705 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18706 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18707 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18708 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018709 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018711res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18712shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18713 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18714 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18715 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18716 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18717 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018718 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18719 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018720
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018721res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18722 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18723 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18724 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018725 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18726 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018728res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18729shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18730 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18731 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18732 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18733 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18734 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018735 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18736 based expect rules.
18737
18738res.hdrs : string
18739 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18740 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18741 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18742 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18743 based expect rules.
18744
18745res.hdrs_bin : binary
18746 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18747 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18748 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18749 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18750 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18751 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18752 (length of 0 for both).
18753
18754 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18755
18756 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18757 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018759res.ver : string
18760resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18761 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018762 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18763 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018765 ACL derivatives :
18766 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018768set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18769 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18770 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018771 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018772 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018774 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18775 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018777status : integer
18778 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18779 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018780 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18781 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018782
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018783unique-id : string
18784 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18785 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18786 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18787 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18788 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18789 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018791url : string
18792 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18793 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18794 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18795 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18796 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18797 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18798 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018800 ACL derivatives :
18801 url : exact string match
18802 url_beg : prefix match
18803 url_dir : subdir match
18804 url_dom : domain match
18805 url_end : suffix match
18806 url_len : length match
18807 url_reg : regex match
18808 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018810url_ip : ip
18811 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18812 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18813 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18814 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18815 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18816 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18817 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018819url_port : integer
18820 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18821 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18822 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18823 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018824
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018825urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18826url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018827 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18828 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018829 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18830 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18831 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18832 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018833 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18834 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018835 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18836 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018838 ACL derivatives :
18839 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18840 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18841 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18842 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18843 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18844 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18845 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18846 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018847
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018849 Example :
18850 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18851 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18852 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18853 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018854
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018855urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018856 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18857 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18858 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018859
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018860url32 : integer
18861 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18862 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18863 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18864 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18865 is an unsigned integer.
18866
18867url32+src : binary
18868 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18869 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18870 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18871
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018872
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200188737.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018874---------------------------------------
18875
18876This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18877used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18878purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18879There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18880or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18881any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18882for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18883
18884internal.htx.data : integer
18885 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18886 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18887
18888internal.htx.free : integer
18889 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18890 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18891
18892internal.htx.free_data : integer
18893 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18894 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18895
18896internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18897 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18898 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18899 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18900
18901internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18902 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18903 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18904
18905internal.htx.size : integer
18906 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18907 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18908
18909internal.htx.used : integer
18910 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18911 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18912 direction.
18913
18914internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18915 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18916 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18917 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18918 of the special value :
18919 * head : The oldest inserted block
18920 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018921 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018922
18923internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18924 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18925 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18926 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18927 integer or one of the special value :
18928 * head : The oldest inserted block
18929 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018930 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018931
18932internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18933 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18934 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18935 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18936 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18937
18938 * head : The oldest inserted block
18939 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018940 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018941
18942internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18943 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18944 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18945 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18946 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18947
18948 * head : The oldest inserted block
18949 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018950 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018951
18952internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18953 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18954 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18955 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18956 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18957
18958 * head : The oldest inserted block
18959 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018960 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018961
18962internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18963 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18964 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18965 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18966 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18967
18968 * head : The oldest inserted block
18969 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018970 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018971
18972internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18973 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18974 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18975 it returns false.
18976
18977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200189787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018979---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018981Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18982every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018983order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018985ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18986---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018987FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018988HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018989HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18990HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018991HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18992HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18993HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18994HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18995LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018996METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018997METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018998METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18999METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19000METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19001METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019002METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019003METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019004RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019005REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019006TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019007WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19008---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019009
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190118. Logging
19012----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019013
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019014One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19015provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19016very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19017provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19018state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019019to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019020headers.
19021
19022In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19023about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19024send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19025
19026 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19027 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19028 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19029 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19030 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019031 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019032 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019033
19034The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19035allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19036as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19037while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19038real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19039delay.
19040
19041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190428.1. Log levels
19043---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019044
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019045TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019046source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019047HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19048in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19049track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19050syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19051about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019052
19053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190548.2. Log formats
19055----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019056
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019057HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019058and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19059slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19060options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019061
19062 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19063 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19064 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19065 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19066 extents.
19067
19068 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19069 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19070 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19071 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19072 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19073
19074 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19075 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19076 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19077 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19078 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19079
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019080 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19081 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19082 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19083 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19084
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019085 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19086
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019087Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19088specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19089field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19090servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19091always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19092identifier.
19093
19094Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19095 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19096 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19097 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19098 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19099
19100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191018.2.1. Default log format
19102-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019103
19104This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19105as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19106format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19107
19108 Example :
19109 listen www
19110 mode http
19111 log global
19112 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19113
19114 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19115 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19116 (www/HTTP)
19117
19118 Field Format Extract from the example above
19119 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19120 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19121 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19122 4 'to' to
19123 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19124 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19125
19126Detailed fields description :
19127 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19128 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19129 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19130 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19131 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19132 and processed the connection.
19133 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19134
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019135In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19136"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19137connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19138
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019139It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19140will eventually disappear.
19141
19142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191438.2.2. TCP log format
19144---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019145
19146The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19147is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19148information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19149counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19150emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19151environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19152the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19153sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019154specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19155not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19156fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19157marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019158
19159 Example :
19160 frontend fnt
19161 mode tcp
19162 option tcplog
19163 log global
19164 default_backend bck
19165
19166 backend bck
19167 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19168
19169 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19170 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19171 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19172
19173 Field Format Extract from the example above
19174 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19175 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19176 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19177 4 frontend_name fnt
19178 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19179 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19180 7 bytes_read* 212
19181 8 termination_state --
19182 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19183 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19184
19185Detailed fields description :
19186 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019187 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19188 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19189 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019190 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019191 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019192 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019193
19194 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019195 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19196 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19197 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019198
19199 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19200 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19201 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019202 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19203 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19204 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19205 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019206
19207 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19208 and processed the connection.
19209
19210 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19211 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19212 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19213 applications.
19214
19215 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19216 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19217 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19218 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19219 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19220
19221 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19222 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19223 See "Timers" below for more details.
19224
19225 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19226 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19227 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19228 "Timers" below for more details.
19229
19230 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019231 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019232 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19233 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19234 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19235 details.
19236
19237 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19238 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19239 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19240 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19241 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19242
19243 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19244 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19245 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19246 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19247 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19248 for more details.
19249
19250 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019251 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019252 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19253 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19254 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019255 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019256
19257 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19258 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19259 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19260 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19261 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19262 caused by a denial of service attack.
19263
19264 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19265 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19266 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19267 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19268 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19269 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19270 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19271 denial of service attack.
19272
19273 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19274 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19275 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19276 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19277 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19278 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19279 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19280 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19281 be processed than on other servers.
19282
19283 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19284 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19285 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19286 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19287 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19288 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19289 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19290 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19291 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19292 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19293 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19294 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19295 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19296
19297 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19298 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19299 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19300 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19301 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19302 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019303 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019304 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19305
19306 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19307 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19308 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19309 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19310 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19311 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019312 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019313 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19314 occurs.
19315
19316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193178.2.3. HTTP log format
19318----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019319
19320The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19321is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19322the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19323are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19324emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19325generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19326"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19327which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019328frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19329is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019330
19331Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19332slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19333with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19334
19335 Example :
19336 frontend http-in
19337 mode http
19338 option httplog
19339 log global
19340 default_backend bck
19341
19342 backend static
19343 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19344
19345 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19346 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19347 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019348 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019349
19350 Field Format Extract from the example above
19351 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19352 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019353 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019354 4 frontend_name http-in
19355 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019356 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019357 7 status_code 200
19358 8 bytes_read* 2750
19359 9 captured_request_cookie -
19360 10 captured_response_cookie -
19361 11 termination_state ----
19362 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19363 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19364 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19365 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19366 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019367
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019368Detailed fields description :
19369 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019370 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19371 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19372 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019373 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019374 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019375 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019376
19377 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019378 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19379 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19380 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019381
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019382 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19383 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019384
19385 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19386 and processed the connection.
19387
19388 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19389 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19390 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19391
19392 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19393 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19394 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19395 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19396 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19397 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19398
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019399 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19400 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19401 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019402 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019403 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19404 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019405 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19406 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019407
19408 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19409 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019410 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019411
19412 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19413 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019414 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19415 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019416
19417 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19418 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19419 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19420 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19421 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019422 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19423 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019424
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019425 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19426 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19427 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19428 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19429 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19430 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19431 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019432 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019433
19434 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19435 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19436 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19437
19438 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19439 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019440 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019441 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19442 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19443 overflowing.
19444
19445 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19446 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19447 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19448 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19449 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19450 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19451 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19452 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19453
19454 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19455 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19456 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19457 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19458 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19459 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19460 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19461 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19462
19463 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19464 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19465 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19466 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19467 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19468 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19469 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19470
19471 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019472 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019473 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19474 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19475 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019476 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019477 system.
19478
19479 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19480 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19481 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19482 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19483 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19484 caused by a denial of service attack.
19485
19486 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19487 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19488 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19489 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19490 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19491 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19492 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19493 denial of service attack.
19494
19495 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19496 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19497 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19498 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19499 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19500 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19501 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19502 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19503 processed than on other servers.
19504
19505 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19506 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19507 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19508 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19509 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19510 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19511 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19512 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19513 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19514 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19515 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19516 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19517 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19518
19519 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19520 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19521 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19522 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19523 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19524 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019525 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019526 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19527
19528 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19529 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19530 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19531 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19532 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19533 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019534 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019535 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19536 occurs.
19537
19538 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19539 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19540 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19541 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19542 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19543 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19544 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19545 cookies" below for more details.
19546
19547 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19548 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19549 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19550 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19551 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19552 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19553 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19554 and cookies" below for more details.
19555
19556 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19557 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19558 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19559 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19560 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19561 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19562 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19563 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19564
19565
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200195668.2.4. Custom log format
19567------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019568
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019569The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019570mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019571
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019572HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019573Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19574separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19575prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19576
19577Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19578variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019579("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019580
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019581If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019582as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019583less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19584the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19585
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019586Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19587"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19588delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19589preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019590
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019591Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19592'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19593https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19594such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19595
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019596Flags are :
19597 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019598 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019599 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19600 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019601
19602 Example:
19603
19604 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19605 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19606
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019607 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19608
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019609At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19610
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019611 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19612 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019613
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019614the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019615
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019616 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19617 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19618 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019619
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019620and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19621
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019622 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19623 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019624
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019625Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19626
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019627 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019628 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019629 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19630 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19631 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019632 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19633 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19634 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019635 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019636 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019637 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019638 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019639 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19640 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019641 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019642 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019643 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019644 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019645 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019646 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019647 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019648 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19649 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19650 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19651 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19652 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019653 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019654 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019655 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019656 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019657 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019658 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19659 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019660 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19661 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19662 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019663 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019664 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19665 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019666 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019667 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19668 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19669 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019670 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019671 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019672 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19673 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19674 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19675 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019676 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019677 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019678 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019679 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019680 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019681 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019682 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19683 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19684 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019685 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019686 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19687 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019688 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019689 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19690 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019691 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019692 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019693 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019694 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019695
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019696 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019697
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019698
196998.2.5. Error log format
19700-----------------------
19701
19702When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19703protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19704By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19705"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019706will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019707logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19708
19709The format looks like this :
19710
19711 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19712 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19713 Connection error during SSL handshake
19714
19715 Field Format Extract from the example above
19716 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19717 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19718 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19719 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19720 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19721
19722These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19723failures.
19724
19725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197268.3. Advanced logging options
19727-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019728
19729Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19730just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19731options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19732for more information about their usage.
19733
19734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197358.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19736------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019737
19738It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19739haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19740commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19741monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19742ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19743
19744 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19745 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19746 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19747 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19748
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019749 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19750 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019751
19752 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19753 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19754 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19755
19756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197578.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19758----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019759
19760The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19761what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19762or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019763"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019764just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19765log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19766after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19767is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19768with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19769with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19770
19771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197728.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19773------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019774
19775Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19776for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19777"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19778retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19779raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19780a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19781file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19782you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19783"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19784
19785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19787--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019788
19789Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19790multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19791them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19792"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19793logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19794error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19795and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19796too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19797useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19798alternative.
19799
19800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198018.4. Timing events
19802------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019803
19804Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19805reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19806the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19807frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019808mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19809addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19810
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019811Timings events in HTTP mode:
19812
19813 first request 2nd request
19814 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19815 t tr t tr ...
19816 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19817 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19818 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19819 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019820 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019821 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19822
19823Timings events in TCP mode:
19824
19825 TCP session
19826 |<----------------->|
19827 t t
19828 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19829 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19830 |<------ Tt ------->|
19831
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019832 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019833 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019834 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19835 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19836 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019837 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019838 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19839 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19840 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19841 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019842
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019843 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19844 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19845 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019846 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19847 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19848 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19849 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19850 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19851 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019852
19853 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19854 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19855 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19856 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19857 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19858 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19859 request typed by hand during a test.
19860
19861 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19862 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019863 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019864 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19865 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19866 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19867 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019868
19869 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19870 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19871 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19872 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19873 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19874
19875 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19876 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19877 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19878 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19879 connection never established.
19880
19881 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19882 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19883 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19884 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19885 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19886 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19887 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19888 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19889 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19890 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19891 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19892
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019893 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19894 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19895 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19896 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19897 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19898 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19899
19900 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19901
19902 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19903 "Ta" can never be negative.
19904
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019905 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19906 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019907 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19908 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019909 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019910
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019911 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019912
19913 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019914 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19915 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019916
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019917 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19918 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19919 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19920 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19921 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19922 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19923 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19924 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19925
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019926These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19927protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19928that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019929due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19930"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19931that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019932
19933Most common cases :
19934
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019935 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19936 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19937 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19938 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19939 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19940 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19941 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19942 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19943 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19944 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19945 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019946 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019947
19948 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19949 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19950 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19951 of ms on remote networks.
19952
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019953 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19954 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19955 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019956
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019957 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19958 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19959 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19960 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19961 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19962 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19963 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19964 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19965 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019966
19967Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19968
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019969 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019970 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019971 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019972
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019973 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019974 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19975 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19976
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019977 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019978 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19979 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19980 flags.
19981
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019982 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19983 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019984 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19985 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19986 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19987 the client connection was maintained open.
19988
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019989 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019990 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019991 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019992 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19993
19994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199958.5. Session state at disconnection
19996-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019997
19998TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19999"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
200002-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20001each of which has a special meaning :
20002
20003 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20004 session to terminate :
20005
20006 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20007
20008 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20009 server explicitly refused it.
20010
20011 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20012 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20013 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20014 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020015 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020016
20017 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20018 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020019
20020 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20021 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20022 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20023 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20024 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20025
20026 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20027 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20028 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20029 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20030 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20031
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020032 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20033 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20034
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020035 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20036 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20037 backup connections when going up.
20038
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020039 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20040
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020041 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20042 send or receive data.
20043
20044 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20045 send or receive data.
20046
20047 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20048 with nothing left in the buffers.
20049
20050 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20051
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020052 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020053 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20054
20055 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20056 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20057 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20058 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20059 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20060
20061 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20062 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20063
20064 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20065 server (HTTP only).
20066
20067 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20068
20069 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20070 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20071 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20072
20073 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20074 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20075 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20076
20077 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20078
20079 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20080 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20081
20082 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20083 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20084 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20085
20086 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20087 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020088 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20089 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020090
20091 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20092 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20093 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20094 another server.
20095
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020096 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020097 server.
20098
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020099 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20100 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20101 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20102 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20103
20104 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20105 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20106 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20107 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20108
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020109 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20110 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20111 "use-server" rule).
20112
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020113 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20114
20115 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20116 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20117
20118 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20119
20120 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20121 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20122 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20123
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020124 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20125 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020126 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020127 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20128 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20129
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020130 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20131
20132 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20133 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20134
20135 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20136
20137 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20138
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020139The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20140was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020141helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20142starvation, attacks, etc...
20143
20144The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20145alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20146easier finding and understanding.
20147
20148 Flags Reason
20149
20150 -- Normal termination.
20151
20152 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20153 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20154 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20155 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20156
20157 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20158 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20159 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20160 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20161 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20162 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020163
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020164 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20165 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020166 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020167
20168 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20169 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20170 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20171
20172 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20173 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20174 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20175 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20176 the server takes too long to respond.
20177
20178 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20179 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20180 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20181 long a time to respond.
20182
20183 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20184 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20185 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20186 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020187 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20188 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020189
20190 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20191 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20192 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20193 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20194 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020195 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020196 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20197 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20198 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20199 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20200 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20201 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20202 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20203 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020204 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020205 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20206 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20207 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020208
20209 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20210 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020211 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20212 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20213 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20214 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020215
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020216 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20217 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020219 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020220 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20221 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020222 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020223 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20224 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20225
20226 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20227 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20228 503 or 504 here.
20229
20230 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20231 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20232 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20233 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20234 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20235
20236 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20237 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020238 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020239 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20240 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20241
20242 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20243 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20244 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20245 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20246 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20247 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20248 between haproxy and the server.
20249
20250 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20251 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20252 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20253 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20254 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20255 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20256 solution is to fix the application.
20257
20258 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20259 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20260 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20261 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20262 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20263 external attacks.
20264
20265 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
20266 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020267 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020268 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20269 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20270
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020271 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20272 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20273 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020274 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020275 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020276
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020277 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20278 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20279 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20280 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020281 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20282 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20283 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20284 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20285 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020286
20287 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20288 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20289 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20290 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20291
20292 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20293 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20294 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20295 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20296
20297 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20298 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20299 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20300 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20301
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020302The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20303persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20304important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20305re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20306
20307 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20308
20309 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20310 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20311 set on a GET request.
20312
20313 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20314 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020315 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020316 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20317
20318 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20319 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20320 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20321
20322 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20323 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20324 already got a cookie.
20325
20326 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20327 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20328 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20329 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20330 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20331
20332 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20333 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20334 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20335
20336 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20337 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20338 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20339
20340 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20341 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20342
20343 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20344 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20345 then advertised in the response.
20346
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203488.6. Non-printable characters
20349-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020350
20351In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20352consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20353converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20354prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20355being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20356escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20357is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20358'}' when logging headers.
20359
20360Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20361issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20362containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20363
20364Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20365the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20366performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20367
20368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203698.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20370---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020371
20372Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20373achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020374section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020375cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20376the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20377the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020378locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020379not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20380user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20381a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20382wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20383
20384 Examples :
20385 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20386 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20387
20388 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20389 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20390
20391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203928.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20393---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020394
20395Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20396proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20397the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20398server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20399
20400Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20401response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020402section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020403
20404It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020405time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20406appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020407are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20408and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20409follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20410request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20411in the logs.
20412
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020413As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20414frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20415an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20416
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020417 Example :
20418 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20419 listen proxy-out
20420 mode http
20421 option httplog
20422 option logasap
20423 log global
20424 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20425
20426 # log the name of the virtual server
20427 capture request header Host len 20
20428
20429 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20430 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20431
20432 # log the beginning of the referrer
20433 capture request header Referer len 20
20434
20435 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20436 capture response header Server len 20
20437
20438 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20439 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20440
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020441 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020442 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20443
20444 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20445 capture response header Via len 20
20446
20447 # log the URL location during a redirection
20448 capture response header Location len 20
20449
20450 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20451 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20452 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20453 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20454 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20455
20456 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20457 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20458 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20459 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020460 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020461
20462 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20463 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20464 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20465 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20466 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020467 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020468
20469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204708.9. Examples of logs
20471---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020472
20473These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20474them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20475reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20476
20477 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20478 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20479 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20480
20481 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20482 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20483
20484 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20485 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20486 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20487
20488 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20489 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20490
20491 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20492 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20493 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20494
20495 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020496 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020497 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20498 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20499
20500 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20501 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20502 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20503
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020504 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20505 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20506 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20507 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20508 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20509 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020510
20511 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020512 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020513
20514 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20515 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20516 Nothing was sent to any server.
20517
20518 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20519 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20520
20521 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20522 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020523 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020524 send a 408 return code to the client.
20525
20526 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20527 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20528
20529 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20530 5 seconds ("c----").
20531
20532 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20533 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020534 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020535
20536 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020537 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020538 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20539 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20540 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20541 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20542 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020543
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020544
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200205459. Supported filters
20546--------------------
20547
20548Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20549accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20550unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20551
20552See also : "filter"
20553
205549.1. Trace
20555----------
20556
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020557filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020558
20559 Arguments:
20560 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20561 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20562
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020563 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020564
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020565 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020566 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20567 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20568 amount of the parsed data.
20569
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020570 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020571
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020572This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20573callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20574information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20575filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20576
20577Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20578tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20579a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20580
20581
205829.2. HTTP compression
20583---------------------
20584
20585filter compression
20586
20587The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20588keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020589when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20590fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20591done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20592explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20593filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20594listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20595order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020596
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020597See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20598 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020599
20600
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200206019.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20602--------------------------------------------
20603
20604filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20605
20606 Arguments :
20607
20608 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20609 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20610 parsed.
20611
20612 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20613 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20614 part must be placed in its own scope.
20615
20616The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20617external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020618streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020619exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20620also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20621
20622SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20623the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20624
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020625For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020626"doc/SPOE.txt".
20627
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100206289.4. Cache
20629----------
20630
20631filter cache <name>
20632
20633 Arguments :
20634
20635 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20636
20637The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20638"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020639cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020640other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20641case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20642is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20643filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020644listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20645order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020646
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020647See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20648 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20649
20650
206519.5. Fcgi-app
20652-------------
20653
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020654filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020655
20656 Arguments :
20657
20658 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20659
20660The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20661request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20662reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20663used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20664implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20665used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20666fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20667used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20668order.
20669
20670See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20671 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20672
20673
2067410. FastCGI applications
20675-------------------------
20676
20677HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20678feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20679the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20680FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20681servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20682FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20683backend.
20684
20685HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20686application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20687connection.
20688
2068910.1. Setup
20690-----------
20691
2069210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20693--------------------------
20694
20695fcgi-app <name>
20696 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20697 document root must be defined.
20698
20699acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20700 Declare or complete an access list.
20701
20702 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20703 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20704 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20705 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20706 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20707
20708docroot <path>
20709 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20710 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20711 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20712
20713index <script-name>
20714 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20715 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20716 is an optional setting.
20717
20718 Example :
20719 index index.php
20720
20721log-stderr global
20722log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20723 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20724 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20725
20726 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20727 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20728
20729pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20730 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20731 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20732 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20733
20734 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20735 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20736 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20737 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20738
20739 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20740 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20741
20742path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020743 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020744 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20745 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20746 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20747 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20748 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20749 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20750 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020751
20752 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020753 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020754 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20755 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20756 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20757 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020758
20759 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020760 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20761 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020762
20763option get-values
20764no option get-values
20765 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20766
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020767 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020768 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20769
20770 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20771 application will accept.
20772
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020773 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20774 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020775
20776 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020777 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020778 option is disabled.
20779
20780 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20781 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20782 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20783 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20784 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20785 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20786
20787option keep-conn
20788no option keep-conn
20789 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20790 sending a response.
20791
20792 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20793 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20794
20795option max-reqs <reqs>
20796 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20797 accept.
20798
20799 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20800 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20801 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20802 to 1.
20803
20804option mpxs-conns
20805no option mpxs-conns
20806 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20807
20808 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20809 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20810
20811set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20812 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20813 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20814 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20815 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20816
20817 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20818 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20819 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20820
20821 Example :
20822 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20823 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20824
20825 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20826
20827
2082810.1.2. Proxy section
20829---------------------
20830
20831use-fcgi-app <name>
20832 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20833
20834 Arguments :
20835 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20836
20837 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20838 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20839 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20840 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20841 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20842
20843 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20844 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20845 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20846 application are evaluated.
20847
20848
2084910.1.3. Example
20850---------------
20851
20852 frontend front-http
20853 mode http
20854 bind *:80
20855 bind *:
20856
20857 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20858 default_backend back-static
20859
20860 backend back-static
20861 mode http
20862 server www A.B.C.D:80
20863
20864 backend back-dynamic
20865 mode http
20866 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20867 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20868
20869 fcgi-app php-fpm
20870 log-stderr global
20871 option keep-conn
20872
20873 docroot /var/www/my-app
20874 index index.php
20875 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20876
20877
2087810.2. Default parameters
20879------------------------
20880
20881A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20882the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020883script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020884applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20885
20886 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20887 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20888 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20889 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20890 | | |
20891 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20892 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20893 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20894 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20895 | | application. |
20896 | | |
20897 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20898 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20899 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20900 | | |
20901 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20902 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20903 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20904 | | the application's configuration. |
20905 | | |
20906 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20907 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20908 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20909 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20910 | | |
20911 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20912 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20913 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20914 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20915 | | be defined. |
20916 | | |
20917 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20918 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20919 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20920 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20921 | | is not set too. |
20922 | | |
20923 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20924 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20925 | | set. |
20926 | | |
20927 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20928 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20929 | | the request. |
20930 | | |
20931 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20932 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20933 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20934 | | |
20935 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20936 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20937 | | script to process the request. |
20938 | | |
20939 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20940 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20941 | | |
20942 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20943 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20944 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20945 | | |
20946 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20947 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20948 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20949 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20950 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20951 | | |
20952 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20953 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20954 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20955 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20956 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20957 | | side. |
20958 | | |
20959 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20960 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20961 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20962 | | connected to. |
20963 | | |
20964 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20965 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20966 | | |
20967 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20968 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20969 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20970 | | |
20971 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20972
20973
2097410.3. Limitations
20975------------------
20976
20977The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20978way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20979during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20980establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20981application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20982or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20983message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20984these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20985and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20986
20987Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20988request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20989requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20990
20991About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20992into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20993fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20994"http-request" ones.
20995
20996Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20997FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20998processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20999must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21000here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021001
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021002/*
21003 * Local variables:
21004 * fill-column: 79
21005 * End:
21006 */